A Treatise on Painting  

From The Art and Popular Culture Encyclopedia

Jump to: navigation, search

Related e

Wikipedia
Wiktionary
Shop


Featured:

A Treatise on Painting is a collection of Leonardo da Vinci's writings entered in his notebooks under the general heading "On Painting". The manuscripts were gathered together by Francesco Melzi sometime before 1542 and first printed in French and Italian as Trattato della pittura by Raphaël Trichet du Fresne in 1651. The main aim of the treatise was to argue that painting was a science.

Contents

Background

As a successful artist, he was given permission to dissect human corpses at the Hospital of Santa Maria Nuova in Florence and later at hospitals in Milan and Rome. From 1510 to 1511 he collaborated in his studies with the doctor Marcantonio della Torre and together they prepared a theoretical work on anatomy for which Leonardo made more than 200 drawings. It was published only in 1680 (161 years after his death) under the heading A Treatise on Painting.

Full text

Translation: John Francis Rigaud

A

TREATISE

ON

PAINTING,

BY

LEONARDO DA VINCI:

FAITHFULLY TRANSLATED FROM THE ORIGINAL ITALIAN,

AND DIGESTED UXDER PROPER HEADS,

By JOHN FRANCIS RIGAUD, Esq.

ACADEMICIAN OF THE ROYAL ACADEMY OF PAINTING AT LONDON,

AND ALSO OF THE ACADEMIA CLEMENTINA AT BOLOGNA,

AND THE ROYAL ACADEMY AT STOCKHOLM.

ILLUSTRATED WITH TWENTY-THREE COPEER-PLATES, AND OTHER FIGURES.


TO WHICH IS PREFIXED A LIFE OF THE AUTHOR,

WITH A CRITICAL ACCOUNT OF HIS WORKS,

Bv JOHN WILLIAM BROWN, Esq.


LONDON:

J. B. NICHOLS AND SON, 25, PARLIAMENT STREET.

SOLD ALSO BY

\V. PICKERING, CUAXCERY LAXE ; J. WEALE, HIGH HOLBORX ;

AND J. WILLIAMS, CHARLES STREET, SOHO.

1835.


Ars est habitus ariDAM faciendi vera cum rationk.

Aristot. Ethic. Lib. 6.


CONTENTS

PAGE

Preface -_„..- v

Preface to Rigaud's Trauslation - - viii

Life of Leonard! da Vinci, by J. W, Brown, Esq. xiii Catalogue of the principal Works painted by Leonardo da Vinci - _ - - - xc

Memoir of J. F Rigaud, Esq. R. A. - - c

Treatise on Painting.

Drawing — Proportion - - -

Anatomy - - - - 13

Motion and Equipoise of Figures - - 27

Linear Perspective - - - .50

Invention, or Composition - - - 63

Expression and Character - - 90

Light and Shadow - - 96

Contraste and Effect - - - 114

Reflexes - - - - 116

Colours and Colouring _ - _ 124

Colours in regard to Light and Shadow - 143

Colours in regard to Backgrounds - lo2

Contraste, Harmony, and Reflexes in regard to Colours - » - - 1.5.5

Perspective of Colours - 163

Aerial Perspective - - 1 80

Miscellaneous Observations.

Landscape, &c. - - 224

General Table of Chapters, with References to the corresponding Chapters in the original Italian . . - . 227

Book

Introductions

PREFACE.


Since the former edition of this work was pub- lished, the able Translator has paid the debt of nature.*

Mr. Rigaud being himself a painter, and highly appreciating the merits of Leonardo da Vinci, felt that he should derive pleasure from exhibiting his well-known Treatise on Painting to the Brit- ish public with superior advantage. He, there- fore, not only gave a new translation, but formed a better arrangement of the materials. The merits of Mr. Rigaud' s Translation ha^nng been duly ap- preciated by the public, and the work having been long out of print, another edition, in a neater and more condensed form, is now produced, which, the Publishers pi'esume, may prove a desirable acquisition to students and amateurs.

The principal novelty, however, of this edition is the new Life of the Author, by the late J. W. Bro"v\m, Esq., which was first published, in a se- parate volume, in 1828. A long residence in Italy, an intimate acquaintance with its language

  • See a memoir of Mr. Rigaud, p. c.

A 3


VI PREFACE.

and literature, together with a constant oppor- tunity of studying the most finished specimens of Art, induced that gentleman to undertake the hiography of Leonardo da Vinci, who so largely contributed to form a new sera in the His tory of the Fine Arts. This distinguished Italian i s not so well known in England as he deserves.

Among the various l)iographical sketches of this celebrated character, that written by Giorgio Va- sari is perhaps the most authentic, as he had the advantage of contemporaneous information. But this also is rather an account of his works than of himself, containing little more than what is gene- rally known, and forming only one article in Va- sari's Lives of celebrated Painters.

To most of the editions which have been pub- lished of Da Vinci's writings a short biographical notice is prefixed, but they are chiefly copied ver- batim from Vasari.

The Signor Carlo Ammoretti, hbrarian of the Ambrosian Library at Milan, has prefixed the best and most ample account of Leonardo da Vinci to the edition of his "Trattato della Pittura," pub- lished at Milan in 1 804 ; which he has entitled " Memorie storiche su la Vita, gli Studj, e le Opere di Leonardo da Vinci."

In addition to many sources of information, Mr. Brown had the privilege of constant admittance not only to the private library of his Imperial and


PREFACE. VU

Royal Highness the Grand Duke of Tuscany, but also to his most rare and valuable collection of Manuscripts in the Palazzo Pitti, where he was permitted to copy from the original documents and correspondence whatever he conceived useful to his subject.

In selecting from the mass of documents rela- tive to the subject of the present work, Mr. Brown rejected whatever appeared unsupported by sufficient proof ; and he has given such historical anecdotes of that period as were necessary to the subject, from their having materially influenced the private fortunes of Da Vinci.


Sept. 5, 1835.


PREFACE


Mr. RIGAUD'S TRANSLATION.


The excellence of the following Treatise is so well known to all in any tolerable degree conversant with the Art of Painting, that it would be almost superfluous to say any thing respecting it, were it not that it here appears under the form of a new translation, of which some account may be ex- pected.

Of the original Work, which is in reality a selec- tion from the voluminous manuscript collections of the Author, both in folio and in quarto, of all such passages as related to Painting, no edition appeared in print till 1651, though its Author died so long before as the year 1519; and it is owing to the circumstance of a manuscript copy of these extracts in the original Italian, having fallen into the hands of Raphael du Fresne, that in the former of these years it was published at Paris in a thin folio volume in that language, accompanied with a set of cuts from the drawings of Nicole


^ TRANSLATOR S PREFACE. IX

Poussin and Albert! ; the former having designed the human figures, the latter the geometrical and other representations. This precaution was pro- bably necessary, the sketches in the Author's own collections being so very slight as not to be fit for publication without further assistance. Poussin's drawings were mere outlines, and the shadows and back-grounds behind the figures were added by Errard, after the drawings had been made, and, as Poussin himself says, without his knowledge.

In the same year, and size, and printed at the same place, a translation of the original work into French was given to the world by Monsieur de Chambray (well known, under his family name of Freart, as the author of an excellent Parallel of ancient and modern Architecture, in French, which Mr. EveljTi translated into English). Tlie style of this translation by Mons. de Chambray, being thought, some years after, too antiquated, some one was employed to rcAise and modernise it ; and in 17H> a new edition of it, thus polished, came out, of which it may be truly said, as is in general the case on such occasions, that whatever the sup- posed advantage obtained in purity and refine- ment of language might be, it was more than counterbalanced by the want of the more valuable qualities of accuracy, and fidelity to the original, from which, by these variations, it became further removed.


X TRANSLATOR S PREFACE.

The first translation of this Treatise into English, appeared in the year 1721. It does not declare by whom it was made ; but though it professes to have been done from the original Italian, it is evident, upon a comparison, that more use was made of the revised edition of the French transla- tion. Indifferent, however, as it is, it had become so scarce, and had risen to a price so extravagant, that, to supply the demand, it was found neces- sary^, in the year 17^6? to reprint it as it stood, with all its errors on its head, no opportunity then offering of procuring a fresh translation.

This last impression, however, being also dis- posed of, and a new one again called for, the present Translator was induced to step forward, and undertake the ofiice of fresh translating it, on finding, by comparing the former versions both in French and English with the original, many pas- sages which he thought might at once be more concisely and more faithfully rendered. His ob- ject, therefore, has been to attain these ends, and as rules and precepts like the present allow but little room for the decorations of style, he has been more solicitous for fidelity, perspicuity, and precision, than for smooth sentences, and well- turned periods.

Nor was this the only advantage which it was found the present opportunity would afford ; for the original work consisting in fact of a number


TRANSLATOR S PREPACK. XI

of entries made at different times, without any regard to their subjects, or attention to method, might rather in that state be considered as a chaos of intelligence, than a well-digested treatise. It has now, therefore, for the iirst time, been at- tempted to place each chapter under the proper head or branch of the art to which it belongs and by so doing, to bring together those which (though related and nearly connected in substance) stood, according to the original arrangement, at such a distance from each other as to make it troublesome to find them even by the assistance of an index ; and difficult, when found, to com- pare them together.

The consequence of this plan, it must be con- fessed, has been, that in a few instances the same precept has been found in substance repeated; but this is so far from being an objection, that it evidently proves the precepts were not the hasty opinions of the moment, but settled and fixed principles in the mind of the Author, and that he was consistent in the expression of his sentiments. But if this mode of arrangement has in the pre- sent case disclosed what might have escaped ob- servation, it has also been productive of more material advantages; for, besides facihtating the finding of any particular passage (an object in itself of no small importance), it clearly shows the work to be a much more complete system than


Xll TRANSLATOR S PREFACE.

those best acquainted with it had before any idea of, and that many of the references in it, appa- rently to other writings of the same Author, relate in fact only to the present, the chapters referred to having been found in it. These are now pointed out in the notes, and where any obscurity has oc- curred in the text, the reader will find some assist- ance at least attempted by the insertion of a note to solve the difficulty.

No pains or expense have been spared in pre- paring the present work for the press. The cuts have been re-engraved wdth more attention to correctness in the drawing, than those which ac- companied the two editions of the former English translation possessed (even though they had been fresh engraven for the impression of 17^6); and the diagrams are now inserted in their proper places in the text, instead of being, as before, col- lected all together in two plates at the end.

J. F, RlGAUD. 1802.


THE LIFE


LEONARDO DA VINCI.


Among the many distinguished individuals who flourished in Italy during the early part of the six- teenth century, there is none more worthy of com- memoration than Leonardo da Vinci, whether we consider his splendid and almost universal talents, or the excellence of his character. Through a long and active life his mind was zealously devoted to the re- vival of the arts, to which he contributed in a greater degree, perhaps, than any single individual of ancient or modern times. The arts of poetry, music, and especially painting, were embraced by him with an enthusiasm which awakened that of others, and gave a mighty impulse to the mental energies, not only of his con- temporaries and countrymen, but of distant nations and posterity. Every incident in the life of such a man must be full of interest to the lovers of biography : the more so from the very remarkable fact, that in no language have those incidents been properly collected, though abundant and authentic sources of information exist on which such a work might be founded. To supply in some degree this deficiency, is the object of the following pages.

b


XIV THE LIFE OF

Leonardo da Vinci was born in the year 1452, at Vinci, in the Val d'Arno Inferiore, on the confines of the Pistoiese territory, not far from the Lake of Fu- cecchio. He was the natural son of Pietro da Vinci ; and it is said that his mother was a servant in his father's family ; but this must remain uncertain, from the length of time that has since elapsed, and the numerous reports that contradict each other, not only in what relates to his origin, but even to the year of his birth, in which there is a difference of no less than ten years. It is, however, certain, that he was entirely brought up in his father's family ; a fact attested by an old and well authenticated register, found among the ancient archives of Florence by Signore Dei, who has written largely on the subject of Leonardo's genealogy. It is a matter of some regret, that, amidst all his learned and elaborate researches, that gentle- man has not been able to procure any documents to prove that Da Vinci was subsequently declared legi- timate, which from various circumstances appears to be extremely probable. If we may believe the regis- ter, and there is no better authority, Leonardo was seventeen years old when his fother was forty ; so that he must have been born when Pietro was a young man, and most likely before his marriage.

His father had three wives, Giovanna daZenobi Ama- dori, Francesca di SerGiulianoLanfredini,and Lucrezia di Guglielmo Cortigiani ; and a proof that Leonardo still formed a part of his family after his third marriage, is afforded by a passage in one of Belincionni's son- nets, addressed to Madonna Lucrezia da Vinci, which begins

" A Fiesole con Piero e Leonardo ;"


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. XV

and relates the pleasures he enjoyed at their villa near Florence. It is hardly probable that he would have received such unvarying attentions, had he been con- sidered merely as a natural child. Moreover, we find from several documents in the " Codice Atlantico," that his family were at all times proud of his relation- ship, and his uncle Francesco da Vinci left him an equal share of his property with his other brothers and sisters.

Leonardo was gifted with one of the finest forms that can be imagined, in which strength and symmetry were beautifully combined ; his face was strongly ex- pressive of his ardent mind, and of the frankness and energy of his character. He would, it may be pre- sumed, have distinguished himself in the literary world while in his youth, had he not been as unsteady as he was enthusiastic in his various pursuits. He made such wonderful progress in arithmetic, that when a child he frequently proposed questions which his mas- ter himself was unable to resolve. He next attached himself to music as a science, and soon arrived at such perfection in playing on the lyre, which was his favourite instrument, as to compose extemporaneous accompaniments to his own poetical effusions. The following sonnet is one of the very few which are extant.

" Chi non jnio quel die vuol, quel che pu6 voglia;

Che quel che non si pub folle i^ il volere.

Adunque saggio ^ I'uomo da tenere

Che da quel che non puo suo voler toglia. Pero che ogni diletto nostro e doglia

Sta in si e no, saper voler potere,

Adunque quel sol pu6 che ^ col dovere,

Ne trae la ragion fuor di sua soglia. 62


XVI THE LIFE OF

Ne sempre ^ da voler quel che I'uom pi)te,

Spesso par dolce quel che torna amaro,

Piansi gii quel che io volsi, poiche io I'hebbi. Adunque tu, letter di queste note,

Se a te vuoi esser buono, e ad altri caro,

Vogli sempre poter quel che tu debbi."

But, although an ardent admirer of the arts in general, painting appeared to be his favourite pursuit, to which he more particularly applied himself in all its different branches 5 and in which he soon attained great excel- lence^as well as in the art of forming models and designs. The praiseworthy exertions of Cimabue^ Giotto, and Masaccio, had already begun to revive the art of painting in Italy, and particularly in Tuscany, where the arts were most certain to find protection and en- couragement, from the powerful patronage of Lorenzo de' Medici, so justly styled the Magnificent." His liberality had already acquired for his native Florence the honourable appellation of the " Modern Athens;" and his taste for literature and the fine arts consider- ably influenced the state of public opinion among his countrymen.

The Signore Pietro, perceiving that his son's abilities and inclinations might lead to future wealth and fame, determined to show the productions of his self-culti- vated talents to Andrea Varocchio, one of the most celebrated painters, sculptors, and architects of that age.* Masser Andrea, surprised at the strong indi-

  • Andrea del Varocchio, or Verrocchio, a Florentine painter,

architect, and jeweller, died at Venice in 1488, where he was enoiployed in forming the equestrian statue of Bartolomeo Cog- lioni in bronze. He was more celebrated as an architect and sculptor than as a painter. — See his life by Vasari.


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. XVll

cations of original talent and hope of future excellence, which these early productions evinced, gladly con- sented to receive the young Leonardo into his "studio," convinced that a pupil of so much merit could not fail of increasing his master's celebrity; but he soon found that his scholar had very little need of his instructions, and that he would ere long surpass him in his own works.

It happened about this time that Messer Andrea was employed to paint a picture of St. John baptizing our Saviour ; and anxious to stimulate his young pupil to greater exertion, he desired his assistance in this composition. Leonardo executed the part assigned him with such extraordinary skill, that, as Vasari relates, the angel painted by him greatly excelled all the rest of Andrea's picture, which, he says, " was the occasion of Messer Andrea's leaving off paint- ing, enraged that a child should know more than himself"

Having given this proof of wonderful abilities, he employed himself in studying the different branches of the art to which he now intended more particularly to devote his attention. But the natural inconstancy of his disposition frequently impelled him to desert his studio, and indulge in imaginary speculations. His time, however, was never unemployed ; and though his occupations were always various, and sometimes inconsistent, he nevertheless most assiduously culti- vated whatever was calculated to adorn his mind or increase his accomplishments. He must also have worked very diligently at his profession, as his father could not have afforded him much money for his amusements ; and he is known, if we may believe his


XVm THE LIFE OF

contemporaries, to have led rather a gay life. The dehght of society wherever he went, and an extraor- dinary favourite with the fair sex, he became too fond of dress and parade ; he maintained a numerous retinue of servants, a sumptuous equipage, and purchased the most spirited horses that could be procured. These extravagances were, however, extremely pardonable in a young man flushed with success and conscious of his superior acquirements, particularly as they could only be supported by the produce of his own industry, and must therefore have greatly tended to stimulate his exertions.

Like most people who are endowed with great na- tural talents, he undertook much more than he was able to accomplish ; and we find him continually changing his occupations : at one time diligently em- ploying himself in astronomical observations, to ascer- tain the motion of the heavenly bodies, at another intently pursuing the study of natural history and botany, yet with all his versatility of talent and incon- stancy of disposition, never permitting himself to neg- lect his favourite pursuit. With the utmost perse- verance he sought every possible means of improving himself in painting, from the time he left the studio of Andrea Varocchio, and became his own master,

Tlie numerous works on scientific subjects that Leonardo has left to posterity, sufficiently prove how well he must have employed his youth, though very little is to be found in the writings of his contempo- raries to give us any information of the occurrences of his every-day life. Both Vasari and Lomazzo relate that he invented various machines for lifting great weights, penetrating mountains, conducting water from


LEOXARDO DA VINCI. XIX

one place to another, and innumerable models for watches, windmills, and presses. Two of the many projects which he had in contemplation, some of which were almost too wild for belief, deserve to be parti- cularly noticed. One of them was to lift up the Ca- thedral of San Lorenzo bodily, or rather en masse, by means of immense levers, and in such a manner that he pretended the edifice would not receive the slightest injury. The other, which was more feasible, was to form the Arno into a canal as far as Pisa, and which would have been extremely beneficial to the commerce of Tuscany.

That Leonardo continued to reside at Florence, or at least in its neighbourhood, is confirmed by the story Vasari relates of the " Rotella del Fico," which was a round piece of wood cut from the largest fig-tree on his father's estate. The Signore Pietro was very fond of field sports and country amusements; and one of his " conladini" who was particularly useful to him on these occasions, brought him a piece of wood, requesting him to have something painted on it as an ornament for his cottage. Willing to gratify his favourite, he desired his son to do as the man wished ; and Leonardo determined to paint something that should astonish his father by the great progress he had made in his art. This piece of wood must have been roughly made and badly put together, as our young artist was obliged to have it planed off and the insterstices filled up with stucco, so as to leave a surface sufficiently smooth for his purpose. He then considered for some time what he should represent, and at length determined on painting a monster that should have the effect of Medusa's head on all be-


XX THE LIFE OF

holders. For this purpose he collected every kind of reptile, vipers, adders, lizards, toads, serpents, and other poisonous or obnoxious animals, and formed a monster so wonderfully designed, that it appeared to flash fire from its eyes, and almost to infect the air with its breath. When he had succeeded to his wishes in this horrible composition, he called his father to try its effect upon him ; who, not expecting what he was to see, started back with horror and affright, and was just going to run out of the room, when Leo- nardo stopped him by assuring him it was the work of his own hands, exclaiming, " that he was quite satis- fied, as his picture had the effect he anticipated." The Signore Pietro was, of course, too much delighted with his son's performance to think of giving it to his " contadino," for whom he procured an ordinary painting, and sold Leonardo's to a merchant of Flo- rence for one hundred ducats. This was a very large sum to give for a picture, when the value of money at the time is remembered ; but it was soon after sold to the Duke of Milan for three times the original cost.

The life of a painter, however celebrated, cannot be expected to furnish the same variety of incidents as that of a warrior or a statesman, though the civil virtues and splendid talents of Leonardo da Vinci were probably more useful to his country than the warlike qualifications of his more ambitious contempo- raries, which were usually accompanied by violence and follor/cd by remorse.

Leonardo da Vinci had now reached his thirty-first year, and was most indefatigable in the study of what- ever might tend to his improvement or increase his knowledge in the art oi' painting, to which he almost


LEONARDO DA VINCI. XXI

exclusively devoted himself. One of his first under- takings was the celebrated " Cartone," pasteboard or rather thick paper, which he designed, by the orders of the King of Portugal, for a piece of tapestry that was to be worked in Flanders for that monarch. This drawing represented the story of Adam and Eve when first tempted to sin, and surpassed every thing which had been seen of the kind.

One of his first pictures was a painting of the Ma- donna, in which he introduced, among other acces- sories, a vase of flowers, so inimitably executed that the dew seemed glittering on the leaves. This pro- duction became afterwards the property of Pope Cle- ment the Seventh, who purchased it at an immense price. For his friend Antonio Segni he formed a design of Neptune drawn in his car by sea-horses through the ocean, surrounded by Tritons^ Mermaids, and all the other attributes of that deity which his fertile imagination could invent. It was some time after presented by Segni's son, Fabio, to Messer Gio- vanni Gaddi, with this epigram : —

" Piaxit Virgilius Neptunum : pinxit Homerus Diim maris undisoni per vada flectit equos : Mente quidem vates ilium coaspexit uterque ; Viaoius est oculis, jureque viucit eos,"

Da Vinci always took great pleasure in delineating the most grotesque figures and extraordinary faces, so that, if he met a man in the street with any peculiarity of ugliness or deformity of countenance, he would follow him until he had a correct idea of his face, and would then draw the person, on his return home, from memory, as well as if he had been present. He not b 5


XXn THE LIFE OP

only studied to perfect himself in giving the mere beauty or deformity of the likenesses he painted, but he sought to give the very air, manner, and expression of the persons represented. He at all times preferred studying from nature to following rules that were then but imperfectly understood ; and he was in the habit of inviting the contadini, and people of the lower orders, to sup with him, telling them the most ridicu- lous stories, that he might delineate the natural ex- pressions of rude delight undisguised by the refine- ments of good breeding. He would then show them their own likenesses, which no one could possibly behold without laughter at the ridiculous faces which he had caricatured, but with so much truth that the originals could not be mistaken.* He was so inde- fatigable in pursuing the object of his ambition, that he neglected no means of procuring fresh studies for his pencil. He would sometimes put himself to the pain of accompanying criminals to the place of execution, and would remain with them in their last moments, that he might catch the expression of their countenances, and delineate the agony of their suffer- ings. In short, there was no branch of his art which he considered unworthy of his attention, aware that perfection in any thing is only to be attained by un- wearied industry and application. We find from Vasari, that it was about this time that he painted a picture for the Grand Duke Cosimo the First, repre- senting an angel in strong light and shade, which was

  • The best of these caricatures were published by Clarke, in

17?6, from drawings by Wenceslaus Hollar, taken from the Portland Museum.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. XXUl

placed by that prince in the collection of the " Palazzo Vecchio," from whence it had been missing for up- wards of a century. Most probably it was turned out of its place from the oversight or carelessness of the directors, who had condemned it to be put aside with a quantity of rubbish, old furniture and frames, which are occasionally sold by order of the Duke's guarda- roba. It was not long since bought by a " rivendi- tore" for twenty-one quatrini, about three pence, and resold to its present possessor, the Signore Fineschi, a drawing-master of Florence, for five pauls, two shil- lings and sixpence. There is no doubt of the origin- ality of this painting, both from the particular style of colouring Leonardo made use of, and the sort of stucco with which it is covered behind, a chemical compo- sition which he is well known to have used to preserve his pictures from the worms when they were painted on wood. It is also most accurately described in Vasari'sLife of Leonardo, in these words: — " Among the best things in the Duke Cosimo's palace is the head of an angel with one arm lifted up in the air, shortened off about the elbow, and the other with the hand on the bosom. It is a very extraordinary thing that this great genius was in the habit of seeking for the very darkest blacks, in order to effect a sort of chiaro scuro, which added more brilliancy to his pic- tures, and gave them more the appearance of night than the clearness of day; but this was in order to increase the relief, and so improve the art of painting." The celebrated picture of the Medusa's head, which is now in the Public Gallery at Florence, was executed about this time, but, as it was a work that required great labour, it, like too many of his undertakings, is


XXIV THE LIFE OF

in an unfinished state. It is a most extraordinary subject, and the snakes are interwoven and grouped together instead of hair with such wonderful skill, that it excites almost as much disgust as admiration.

The fame of Leonardo's extraordinary abilities spread through Italy, and he was invited by several princes to reside at their courts, and enrich their palaces with his works. The example of the great Lorenzo had raised an emulation among the princes of Italy for the encouragement of literary men ; and whoever was distinguished by talent was sure not only of wealth and preferment, but was flattered and caressed by all his superiors. The unusual tranquillity Italy en- joyed from the wise precautions and conciliatory policy of Lorenzo de' Medici, left her turbulent rulers at leisure to cultivate the arts of peace. Their habitual restlessness required employment; and reduced to inaction by the temporary cessation of their petty wars and intrigues, their ambition consisted in drawing to their respective courts the greatest men of that lumi- nous period. Lorenzo may therefore be justly styled not only the Maecenas of Florence, which he governed, but of the age in which he lived, as his politics so ma- terially influenced the revival of literature and the progress of general civilization.

Anxious to secure to himself a certain provision for his expensive style of living, Leonardo addressed a letter to Ludovico Sforza, surnamed II Moro, offering his services to that prince, who governed Milan during his nephew's minority, and whom he knew to be most desirous of attracting to his court all the literati of the age, under the pretence of assisting him in the young


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. XXV

Duke's education.* None of the writers of that period have given any reason why Leonardo preferred the patronage of Ludovico to that of the house of Medici, particularly as the latter were distinguished by their liberal encouragement of the arts. Perhaps Lorenzo might have sent him to II Moro, with whom he was in strict alliance, or Leonardo might have preferred Milan himself, where he would have hoped to have found a more extensive field for the exercise of his talents, and less competition than he must have had to contend with at Florence. The uncertainty of his birth perhaps influenced so high minded a man ; and he prubablv wished to establish his own fortunes at a strange court, where he was only known as an illus- trious Florentine distinguished by his sovereign for the superiority of his talents and acquirements. Whatever migiit have been Da Vinci's motive, it is certain that he entered the service of the Duke of Milan, and consented to receive an annual salary of five hundred scudi, which was then by no means a contemptible sum. He was, moreover, entitled to various privileges and immunities, and permitted to appropriate to his own use the produce of such of his paintings as were not executed by the Duke's order.

It is important to the history of Leonardo da Vinci to fix, as nearly as possible, the period of his arrival at Milan. From the most authentic sources it appears that he must have taken up his residence there pre-

  • It is a curious fact, that Leonardo da Vinci always wrote

from riglit to left, like the Persians, for which no one has Jjeen able to account. It was most probably a lo.e of singularity; and, although it increases the difficulty of decyphering his ma- nuscripts, it also serves to place their identity beyond dispute.


XX\1 THE LIFE OF

vious to the year 14-87 j for we find in an old treatise entitled " Delia Luce e dell' Ombra," in his oHn hand-writing, the following observation : " A di 2'J d' Aprile 1490, chominciai questo libro, e richominciai il Cavallo." * In this memorandum he no doubt alludes to the equestrian statue of Francesco Sforza the First, which, if he recommenced in 1490, he must have begun long before, as it must have consumed much time to form the necessary moulds and designs. Moreover, he is alluded to b}' Belincionni, a Florentine poet, who resided at the court of Ludovico il Moro, and celebrated most of the principal events of that period, under the name of the " Apelle Florentine : "

" Qui come 1' apeal miel viene ogni dotto, Di virtuosi ha la sua corte piena : Da Fiorenza un Apelle ha qui condotto ;" &c. f

and the editor Tantio, or Tanzi, has added in the margin, fearing it might not be understood, " Magistro Leonardo da Vinci."

There is also another authority not less respectable than the former, in the RIcordi of ^lonsignore Sabba da Castiglione, which dates his coming to Milan as far back as 1483, from the circumstance of his having been an eye-witness to the destruction of this un- finished equestrian statue, when the French under Charles the Eighth took possession of Milan, in 14'99, There is no evidence to confirm the assertion of this

  • " On the 23rd of April, 1490, I began this book, and re-

commenced the horse."

f " Like bees to hive, here flocks each learned sage,

With all that's great and good his court is throng'd : From Florence fair hath an Apelles come," &c.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. XXVll

noble Milanese writer that liis contemporary Leonardo had worked at this model for sixteen years ; but there is no reason to disbelieve him when he declares he saw the bowmen of Gascony make use of this magnificent production as a target.

Ludovico il Moro, at whose request Leonardo went to the court of Milan, although only nominally Regent, governed that state with absolute authority ; for his nephew, Giovan Galeazzo, possessed merely the title, and enjoyed the pageantry of sovereignty, without the slightest power.

Ludovico Sforza, surnamed II Moro," not from his darkness of complexion, as is erroneously stated by Gibbon, but from his having taken a mulberry-tree, in Italian " Moro," for his de^■ice,* was a prince of great talents, and one of the first politicians of the age. Although the more noble qualities of his mind were obscured by ambition, he was greatly beloved by all who were about his person, and admitted to his intimate society. He was frank and pleasing in his manners, easy of access, and liberal even to profusion to those who possessed his confidence. To a very handsome and prepossessing exterior he united the most powerful eloquence. He successfully cultivated

  • " The Signore Ludovico Sforza, Duke of Milan, adopted

a mulberry-tree, Moro, as bis device, from its beiug considered wiser than all other trees, as it buds later, and does not flower until it has escaped the injuries of winter, when it immediately bears fruit : thereby demonstrating itself of a nature to do no- thing hastily, but rather maturely to reflect, and then promptly execute. This wise prince made use of this device as emblematic of a similarity of disposition." — See Giovio, Vi(e d'Uomini ll'.ustri.


XXVlll THE LIFE OF

the arts of peace, and lost no opportunity of drawing to his court those who had most distinguished them- selves in the arts and sciences. It was his opinion that much more might be done by council than by arras; and that the pen was frequently of more weight than the sword ; he was therefore averse to warlike enterprises, and always preferred obtaining his object by overreaching his adversaries in politics and intrigue. To such a man Leonardo da Vinci must have been invaluable. His various talents, to a prince who so well knew how to appreciate them, were of the great- est importance, and he was received at his court with every possible demonstration of favour and affection. It would far exceed the limits of this work to enumerate all the celebrated men whom Ludovico had drawn around him under the laudable pretence of his ne- phew's instruction and amusement. The poet Belin- cionni has enumerated them in his various composi- tions ; and Leonardo is also mentioned in most ho- nourable terms .

" Del Vinci e suoi pennelli e suoi colori, I moderni e gli auticlii hanno paura."*

The Padre Luca Paciolo, who was the friend and companion of Leonardo and the great restorer of ma- thematics in Italy, places our hero before all his con- temporaries, and makes the following playful allusion to his name : " H Vince in scoltura, getto, e pittura, con ciascuna il nome verifica." f

Vasari is greatly mistaken in supposing that Ludo-

  • Vinci and his pencils and his colours, both moderns and

ancients have in dread.

t " Vinci in sculpture, casts, and painting, verifies his name with all."


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. XXIX

vico sent for Da Vinci merely to amuse him with his musical talents ;* for it appears very improbable that this prince, who was so well aware of Leonardo's knowledge and taste for the fine arts, from having the famous " Rotella del Fico" in his possession, which was painted by him when a young man, should have considered him in the light of a musician. Whatever reputation he might have gained for playing on the lyre, it is evident that he himself considered that accomplishment a mere pastime, as he never makes the slightest mention of his musical abilities in the celebrated letter addressed by him to the Duke of Milan : and if the enlightened politics and vast ideas of Ludovico il Moro are considered, it will be readily conceived that Leonardo was sent for with the view of giving instruction to others as well as of working him- self, by instituting an academy of arts and sciences, of which he was to have the chief direction. We know also from the best historians of the period, that this wary prince, from the moment of his brother Galeazzo Maria's assassination, had formed the plan of usurping his throne, and therefore was particularly anxious to draw over to his party the most celebrated men in Italy 3 as the protection and patronage of such

  • '* It is true that he was an excellent musician and a particularly

good performer on the lyre ; so much so, that Lommazo reputes him superior to every one in that art. A note is to be seen in his Codex, marked Q. R. p. 28, where a new viola is mentioned of his construction ; and in another place there is a drawing by him for a lyre. Vasari speaks of a lyre which belonged to him in the form of a horse's head, the greatest part of which was silver ; and I saw his portrait done with a guitar in his hand for the frontispiece of an old parchment manuscript dedicated to Cardinal Ascanio Sforza." See Ammoretti.


XXX THE LIFE OF

eminent persons could not fail to increase his reputa- tion and strengthen his power. The advantage of such a mode of proceeding had been ah-eady seen in the popularity of the Medici at Florence, and of his own ancestors the Visconti at IMilan. That painting was never neglected in Lombardy, is shown by the Abbate Lanzi, in his " Storia Pittorica," in which he observes, that " while the whole of Europe was ob- scured by the grossest ignorance, Lombardy still pre- served the use, and cultivated a general taste for the art of painting, of which there are several monu- ments still existing ; amongst others the church of Galiano, about six miles to the south of Como, painted in the year 1007."

When Giotto came to Milan, which undoubtedly was previous to 1334, to paint the Visconti palace, that art assumed a superior character, and created a school which has produced many great men, whose works are still preserved in some of the ancient churches and in the private collections of several indi- viduals. There is a lasting monument of the revival of sculpture in the church of San Francesco, done in the year 1316, representing the transit of the Blessed Virgin, in marble, and two other monuments, the work of Giovanni da Pisa, finished in 1339. The improve- ment of architecture may be dated from the time when Gian Galeazzo Visconti invited the first masters to Milan in order to construct the cathedral ; but they had not then abandoned the Gothic style. The Abbate Lanzi's work just cited, will show the pi'ogress made in the arts and sciences until the arrival of Leonardo ; but a great deal is to be gathered from the inedited


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. XXXI

Memoirs of the Painters, Sculptors, and Architects of Milan, by the late Antonio Albuzzi.

Leonardo now found himself in possession of what was then considered an affluent fortune, which relieved his mind from the consideration of being obliged to provide for liis own support. He found Ludovico an easy patron, and was much delighted with his situa- tion. Caressed and flattered by the whole court, he entered with all the energy of his character into the pleasures and amusements of the gay world, and made almost daily progress in the confidence and good opinion of Ludovico, by flattering his wishes and sharing his amusements. By turns a poet, a painter, a musician, and always a most accomplished courtier, he completely gained II JNIoro's favour, who, although a crafty politician and a man of sense, was, neverthe- less, open to flattery, and unable to resist the fascina- tions of such versatile talents. Ludovico was a great lover of pleasure, and was almost as much distin- guished by the dissolute intrigues and lascivious amours of his private life, as by the sagacity and steadiness of his public conduct ; and whilst Da Vinci assisted at his councils, and adorned the city with public buildings, he likewise painted his mistresses, and diverted his leisure hours with music and poetry ; in short, he was always ready either for his patron's service or pleasure.

The first public work in which Leonardo was em- ployed after his arrival at Milan, was the celebrated equestrian statue of Francesco Sforza the First, which, if we may believe the authority before cited of Mon- signore Sabba da Castiglione, he began in 1483. Ac- cording to the poet Taccone, it would have been


XXXn THE LIFE OF

sooner commenced had any one been found capable of undertaking it : —

" E se pill presto non s' ^ principiato, La voglia del Signore fu sernpre pronta : Non s'era ua Leonardo ancor trovato, Che di presente tanto ben I'impronta," &c.*

From the high opinion entertained of his taste, Leo- nardo was made director of all the public fetes and entertainments either given by the sovereign, or to him by the lords of his court j of which Belincionni has preserved the recollection in the poems written by him on these occasions ; and if Tantio, who collected and published them, has observed a proper chronolo- gical order, we may date the two representations in praise of Patience and Labour, given by the Sanse- verini family in honour of the nuptials of Isabella and Beatrice, to the first year of his residence at Milan. To this period we may also refer Leonardo's celebrated portraits of Ludovico's two favourites, Cecilia Gal- lerani and Lucrezia Crevelli, so frequently celebrated by the poets of that age,

Belincionni's sonnet on the picture of the former does more honour to the painter than the poet :

" Di che t' adiri, a chi invidia hai Natura !

Al Vinci che ha ritratto una tua stella.

Cecilia si, bellissima, oggi & queUa

Che a' suoi begli occhi, il sol par ombra oscura. L' onor d tuo, sebben con sua pittura

La fa che par che ascolti, e non favella.

  • " And if this work was not sooner begun,

The sovereign's will was always ready, But a Leonardo had not then been found, Who at this time so well undertakes it."


LEONARDO DA VINCI. XXXIII

Pensa quanto sara piU viva e bella,

Pill a te fia gloria nell' eta futura. Ringraziar dunque Lodovico, or puoi,

E 1' ingegno e la man di Leonardo

Che a' posted di lei voglion far parte. Che lei vedra cosl, bench^ sia tardo,

Vederla viva dirk : basti a noi

Comprender or quella, ch' e naturaed arte."

This portrait was at Milan at the end of the last cen- tury, in the Marchese Bonesana's collection, and there is a fine old copy in tlie Public Gallery. The Gallerani married Count Ludovico Pergamino ; she was a lady of very great talents, and a poetess. Da Vinci painted one of his best pictures for her, repre- senting the Virgin and Child in the act of blessing one of those roses, vulgarly called " Rose della Madonna;" and this picture was in the possession of a wine-nner- chant at Milan when the French occupied that city during the late war. It is framed in the fashion of those times, witli a scroll bearing this inscription :

" Per Cecilia qual te orna, lauda, e adora E'l tuo unico figlio, o beata Vergine exoi-a! "

The portrait of Lucrezia Crevelli, which was not less celebrated and admired than that of her fair con- temporary, is now in the Louvre at Paris.

The greatest proof of the esteem and consideration in which II Moro must have held Leonardo, not only as a painter, sculptor, and mechanic, but also as a man well versed in all the arts and sciences, is his having chosen him to be the founder and director of the academy he caused to be established. The Padre Luca Paciolo informs us, that that prince had long been desirous of forming a union of learned men and


XXXIV THE LIFE OF

skilful artists, who might reciprocally communicate their knowledge, and forward the progress of literature and the arts. That such an academy existed at Milan, the first that was ever known in that city, and to which Leonardo gave his name, is proved by the tes- timony of Vasari, and by several manuscripts still existing in the Ambrosian Library, and also by six engravings representing several ingenious devices, in the centre of which is inscribed " Academia Leonard! Vinci.

It is most probable, that for the use of this academy, and for the purpose of argument with his colleagues and instruction to his pupils, Leonardo wrote all those tracts which are to be found, not only in his " Trattato della Pittura," but in several manuscript volumes which are now preserved in the Public Gallery at Milan. This would easily explain his reasons for undertaking so many and such various argimients ; and would also account for the number of unconnected ideas, unfinished sketches, memoranda, and materials for the composition of future works, as well as several complete and highly finished discourses. Among the latter, his " Trattato della Pittura," is generally consi- dered as one of his best and most useful compositions ; so much so that the Count Algarotti has not hesitated to declare, that even in the present day he should not desire any better elementary work on the art of paint- ing ; an opinion entertained by many other distin- guished writers.

Although it is now almost impossible to fix the exact epoch of the foundation of the Vincean aca- demy, it must have been about the year 1485 or 1486, as, previous to that time, we know that Leonardo was


LEONARDO DA VINCI. XXXV

engaged in forming the model of the equestrian statue of Francesco Sforza, and afterwards in painting the two portraits of Ludovico's mistresses which have been mentioned.

In 1489 we find Da Vinci occupied by his patron's orders in preparing a grand fete wl)ich was to be given in celebration of the young Duke Giovan Galeazzo's marriage with Isabella of Arragon. For this enter- tainment he invented a moving representation of the planets, which, as they approached the royal party in their evolutions, opened of themselves, and discovered a person dressed to represent the deity attributed to each planet, who recited verses composed by Belin- cionni in honour of the occasion.* We also learn from an old manuscript, in which there is a memoran- dum in his hand-writing, that he invented and directed a sort of joust, or tournament, given by Messer Gale- azzo da Sanseverino to the Duke and his court ; which he incidentally mentions from the circumstance of his servant Jachomo having committed a theft on the occasion.

In 1492, II Moro having formed a plan to turn the waters of the Ticino, in order to fertilize the country to the right of that river, had recourse to Leonardo's knowledge of hydraulics to carry his intentions into execution. We know from his notes, that about that time he visited Sesto Calende, Varal pombio, and

  • The reader will find an account of these f^tes in the Ricordi

of Monsignore da Castiglione ; and Beliucionni's verses are in- cluded in his works, collected and published by Tantio, at Milan, in 1495, which are now extremely scarce.


XXXVl THE LIFE OF

Vegevano, where " ai 20 di Marzo del 1492," he observes that " nella vernata le vigne si sotterano."

In this manner Ludovico continued to avail himself of Da Vinci's various talents, and kept him constantly employed, not only as a painter, but also in superin- tending the magnificent entertainments given either by himself or his nobles, in directing the public works, and in ornamenting his palaces.^

It is generally supposed that Leonardo first in- troduced the art of engraving on wood and copper, and that the designs of several old plates, representing the most celebrated literary men at Ludovico's court, were of his composition. It is also said that these were the first examples of an author's portrait being prefixed to his works, unless we credit Pliny's account that the Romans were accustomed to make use of engravings on wood. His beautiful picture of the Virgin and Child with St John and St. Michael, now in possession of Count San Vitale, of Parma, is dated in that year 5 and, what is almost without example

  • To give some idea of the manner in which the Hall of the

Castle of Milan was painted, and of the prices in those days, the following note is transcribed, viz.

" The narrow border round the top of the room, 30 lire. The moulding underneath, each square separately, 7 do. ; and the expense of blue, gold, bistre, indigo, and gum, 3 do. Three days' labour. — Pictures under the pannels, 12 lire each. Each of the arches, T lire. The cornice under the windows, 6 soldi the brace. For 24 stories from the Roman History, 10 lire. An ounce of blue, 10 soldi. Gold, 15 soldi. Black, 2^ do. Five days' labour in the composition," &c. &c.

N. B. The Italian lira is about S^d. English, and the soldo is as nearly as possible a French sous.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. XXXVU

in his works, is inscribed, " Leonardo Vinci fece^ 14-92."

About the end of the autumn in 14-94:, Charles the Eighth invaded Italy, and repaired to Pavia, where 11 Moro had prepared the most magnificent fetes and entertainments for his reception, and the arrangement of the whole was entrusted to the elegant taste of Leo- nardo da Vinci.

During his residence at Pavia, Leonardo, who never permitted any opportunity to escape him by which he could acquire information, determined to employ his time in studying the anaton)y of the human frame under the instructions of Marc' Antonio della Torre, a learned Genoese, and one of the most celebrated professors of that university. These two great men were equally pleased with each other ; the professor deriving much benefit from the correct drawings Leonardo executed to illustrate their studies, and the latter being greatly improved by the thorough know- ledge of the human frame which he thus acquired.

It was always Da Vinci's opinion that a perfect acquaintance with anatomy was essentially necessary to a painter, and that without it he could not hope to attain any excellence in his art, — a doctrine which he has enforced in a manuscript now existing in the Am- brosian Library at Milan. " It is necessary that a painter should be a good anatomist, that in his atti- tudes and gestures lie may be able to design the naked parts of the human frame, according to the just rules of the anatomy ol the nerves, bones, and muscles ; and that in his different positions he may know what particular nerve or muscle is the cause of such a par- ticular movement, in order tl)at he may make that c


XXXVm THE LIFE OF

only marked and apparent, and not all the rest, as many artists are in the habit of doing ; who. that they may appear great designers, make the naked limbs stiff and without grace, so that they have more the appearance of a bag of nuts than the human superficies, or rather more like a bundle of radishes than naked muscles,"

In this manner Leonardo and his learned instructor pursued their studies together, deriving equal advan- tage from the exertion of their respective talents. Da Vinci used to draw the naked parts of the human frame in red chalk ; while his friend described them with such admirable skill, that Vasari declares he was the first who brought the science of anatomy into general repute, by rendering it plain to all. Some of these drawings are preserved in the Royal Library in Lon- don, as the celebrated Dr. Hunter, in his course of Anatomical Lectures published in 1784, mentions having seen them, and greatly admires the precision with which they are executed, particularly in the most minute parts of the muscles.

From Pavia Charles, still accompanied by Ludovico and his court, repaired to Piacenza, and there soon after received intelligence of Giovan-Galeazzo's death. This occasioned II Moro's immediate return to Milan ; when the Ducal Council, privately suborned, decreed that the crown should be confirmed to him in prefer- ence to Giovan-Galeazzo's infant children, as they considered it necessary to the general good to place the government in the hands of a powerful prince, who could defend the state and provide for its security amidst the broils and misfortunes which threatened the tranquillity of Italy.


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. XXXIX

In the mean time Leonardo had returned to ?»Iilan from Pavia, where he left his friend Marc' Antonio della Torre, and recommenced his exertions for his patron Ludovico, who, now firmly established as Duke of iMilan by the voice of the people, the connivance of the French King, and the Emperor's grant, had greater leisure for the cultivation of the fine arts. He was a prince of quiet habits, mild in his manners, and parti- cularly averse to bloodshed — so much so, that we may doubt his having been at all concerned in his nephew's death. In order to gain the favour of the people, he amused them with continual entertainments, and col- lected around him the greatest men from all parts of Italy, who by their talents and accomplishments might contribute to the embellishment of his city, or the refinements of his court. The poet, the historian, and the painter, equally shared his patronage, and were equally zealous in their demonstrations of gratitude. The court of Milan became what that of Florence had ceased to be ; the latter being desolated by in- ternal broils, the arts of peace fled to a more congenial soil, and Ludovico was now the great patron of the fine arts, and the restorer of literature in Italy.

Shortly after his return to Milan, Leonardo was called upon to celebrate the Duke's virtues, and de- signed a picture of which we find a description in his own writing: " II Moro representing Fortune, with flowing hair and his hands extended, and Messer Gualtiere in the act of doing homage to him in the foreground ; Poverty in frightful guise is pursuing a youth whom II Moro is sheltering under his robe, while with his golden rod he menaces the monster, and warns him not to approach."

c2


xl THE LIFE OF

From several memoranda and remarks which are to be found among his manuscripts, such as, "A di 24- Marzo l^S^, venne Galeazzo a stare meco, con il patto di dare 5 lire il mese, pagando ogni l^ di del mese. Datemi da suo padre fiorini due di Reno ; *' and a little lower down, " A di 14' di Luglio ebbe da (jaleazzo fiorini 2 di Reno," — it is evident he was in the habit of receiving scholars who paid him for the benefit they derived from his instructions, and the information they gained by frequenting his studio.

In the year l^QS there is no mention of any parti- cular work having been undertaken by Leonardo, It is most probable that he was occupied in perfecting the Vincian Academy ; as it is supposed he wrote his famous Treatise addressed to the Duke about this time, in which he examines the respective merits of the two arts, painting and sculpture. It is much to be lamented that this book is no longer extant, as it would have been highly interesting to know the opi- nion of one so capable of forming a proper judgment from his extensive knowledge of the fine arts. Leo- nardo's treatise was composed for the use of the Aca- demy, and is even now held in general estimation. In the collection of his works lately published at Paris, there are several tracts comparing the different merits of the sister arts, both considered relatively and indi- vidually, which prove that this treatise really existed; and it is moreover frequently alluded to in the " Trat- tato della Pittura," written by Lomazzo, who was his friend and scholar.

Leonardo's pencil was not, however, unemployed during this year, as the Duke ordered him to paint his own and the Duchess's portraits on each side of a


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Xli

large picture representing Mount Calvary, which Montorfani had painted on the wall of the refectory in the Convento delle Grazie. This task he very unwil- lingly undertook, if we may believe Padre Gattico, a Dominican friar, who has left an account of this con- vent in manuscript, in which he says : " Quelle pitture si sono infradiciate per essere dipinte all' olio, perche V olio non si conserva in pitture fatte sopra mure e pietra." * About the end of this year, a curious work was printed at Milan on music, by Franchino Gaforio, which was preceded by an engraving, supposed to have been done by Leonardo, or by one of his scholars under his direction and with his assistance.

In the year 1496, Da Vinci derived much pleasure from the arrival of his friend and countryman the Padre Luca Paciolo, who has been before mentioned in these pages. As they had studied together, and were equally well versed in mechanics, mathematics, and architecture, they were mutually delighted with each other's society, and Leonardo had sufficient in- fluence with the Duke to persuade him to receive his friend into his service. Engaged in the same pursuits, they lived in the same house, shared the same studies and amusements, and assisted each other in their separate undertakings. Paciolo prevailed on his friend to draw all the geometrical figures for his Treatise on Architecture, as he well knew there was no one cap- able of executing them with the same precision ; and he acknowledges this assistance in the following well- merited eulogium : " As in the disposition of the

  • " These pictures have mouklered away in consequence of

their being painted in oil, because oil does not keep in paintings made upon walls and stone,"


xlii THE LIFE OF

regular bodies, you will observe those which are done by that most worthy painter, architect, musician, and universally endowed Leonardo da Vinci, a Florentine, at the city of Milan, when we were both in the pay of the most excellent Duke Ludovico Maria Sforza, in the year of our salvation HQG,"

A little further on he mentions the drawings which Leonardo made for his work on the " Divina propor- tioned" which he dedicated in manuscript to the Duke Ludovico. They were sixty in number, and were published in 1509, with a new dedication to Pietro Soderini, Gonfaloniere of Florence, to whom he writes : "^ Libellum .... Ludovico Sportiae nuncupavi tanto ardore, quoque sua Vincii nostri Lionardi manibus scalpta," &c.

To this period also belongs the drawings, or rather illustrations, of the celebrated " Codice Triulziano," which was written by the Duke's eldest son, Maximi- lian, when a child studying the Latin language. This manuscript forms a small quarto volume written on parchment, which, besides being ornamented with numerous highly finished devices and heraldic embla- zonments, is enriched with several pictures relating to the youth and occupations of the young prince, who then possessed the title of Count of Pavia. Among these there are two which are generally considered the production of Leonardo's pencil : one representing the Count in the act of doing homage to his cousin the Emperor Maximilian 5 and the other, of the same prince amusing himself catching birds, while his tutor, Count Secco di Borella, is advising him to leave off his diversions and attend to his studies. This manu- script is held in the greatest estimation, and is still preserved at Milan.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. xliii

About the end of this year Ludovico il Moro went to Pavia, attended by all his court, to meet the Em- peror Maximilian, whom he had invited into Italy. Triumphal arches were prepared everywhere on his road, and most magnificent fetes awaited his arrival wherever he stopped ; as Ludovico disguised his true reason for this conference under the pretence of merely doing homage to his feudal lord. Leonardo, who accompanied his patron on this occasion, had no doubt a principal share in arranging these festivities. That he was not forgotten by the Duke is proved by his having ordered him to paint a picture of the Nati- vity, which he presented to the Emperor in honour of the occasion, and which is now in the Imperial cabinet at Vienna.

Leonardo's residence at the court of Milan, although extremely agreeable to himself, was highly detrimental to his fame as a painter; as he was so constantly occupied in different works for the good of the state and the amusement of the court, that he could not devote so much of his time to painting as his admirers wish. A number of those pictures which are really his own, are left in an unfinished state, from the ex- treme nicety of his taste. His imagination went so far beyond what it is in the power of man to execute, that he was seldom or ever contented with his own works, and he would frequently lay aside a picture altogether, if it did not equal his ideas of the subject. At other times he would hastily abandon an under- taking, if his design did not embrace all that his ima- gination had preconceived. Hence there remain so few pictures by this inimitable artist ; but these few are so very highly finished, that no one since has been


xliv THE LIFE OF

supposed to have surpassed him. Many of the pictures wliich are shown in Italy as Leonardo's paintings, are falsely considered so, particularly in Milan, where they are generally the work of some of his scholars, with the advantage of receiving the last touches from himself.

There could have been no part of Da Vinci's life more pleasant to himself than the time he spent at Milan previous to the misfortunes of the house of Sforza. In the full enjoyment of his princely patron's confidence and favour, he lived in the most splendid manner, beloved and respected by every body. Free from all care for present wants, and too little accus- tomed to consider the future, he passed his time in the gratification of his favourite pursuits, and devoted his leisure to the entertainment of his friends, Ex- pensive in his habits, he kept a most liberal table ; his house was always open to whoever was distinguished for talents or accomplishments J and he drew around him the best society in Milan during that brilliant period. He sought for merit wherever it was to be found, for the rust of envy never corroded his noble heart, and the poorest artist was always welcome to a seat at his board and a share of his purse.

His principal object in life was the encouragement of literature and the arts, in all their various branches j and, enthusiastically desirous of promoting what he most loved, he assisted the poor, encouraged the weak, and brought forward the unknown. It is only to be regretted that his means did not equal his inclinations j for his profuse liberality rendered him but ill qualified to give assistance to others ; and unfortunately his friend and patron Ludovico il Moro had exactly the


LEONARDO DA VINCI. xlv

same propensities. He also undertook more than he was capable of finishing ; his ideas were too much enlarged for his situation, which impoverished his treasury, diminished his revenues, and became the principal cause of his ultimate ruin. A proper atten- tion to his expenditure is as necessary to a prince as to an individual, without which, even with the very best intentions, neither can be certain of remaining honest. The one must oppress his subjects, the other must defraud his equals ; and both must risk the loss of that claim to assistance in the hour of need which both may occasionally require. Upon no one was this truth more severely impressed than on Ludovico il Moro, who, although he had exhausted his finances in beautifying his city and encouraging the arts, was neglected by his subjects when they found he had ex- hausted his resources ; and they left him to pay the forfeit of his imprudence and ambition with the loss of his dominions and his life.

On his return to Milan from Pavia, the Duke was desirous of enriching his capital with some great work that should be considered worthy of Da Vinci's talents, and serve to perpetuate the fame of the artist and the liberality of the prince. With this idea Ludovico de- sired Leonardo to paint his celebrated picture of" The Last Supper," on the walls of the refectory in the Dominican Convent of the " Madonna delle (jrazie."

It was almost impossible to have selected a subjec more adapted to Leonardo's taste and genius, and he had certainly never before undertaken so interesting a work. lie proposed to represent the moment when our Saviour exclaims " Amen dico vobis quia unus vestram rae traditurus est." This gave him an oppor-


xlvi THE LIFE OF

tunity of exercising his peculiar talent, of representing the different passions that agitate the human frame, and of giving to each individual of his picture the merit and interest of a separate composition, without disturbing the harmony of the whole.

It is not exactly known when he commenced this picture, but from various circumstances it appears that it must have been about the year 1497, as Bottari tells us there is a rude engraving bearing that date, and supposed to be Leonardo's own work. The Padre Luca Paciolo mentions, in one of his manuscripts, that in 1498 Leonardo had already considerably advanced in drawing the outlines of this composition j and who- ever observes it now, at least as much as is spared to us from the ravages of time and the attacks of ignor- ance, will easily perceive that three or even four years are very little to have employed on such an under- taking ; the more so when we consider Leonardo's extreme difficulty in being satisfied with his own pro- ductions. It is also to be remembered, that he was obliged to form a cartoon of the same size as his picture.

The general disposition of this admirable work is considered extremely simple, and therefore the more appropriate to the subject. Our Saviour is repre- sented seated in the middle, which is the place of honour : his attitude is tranquil and majestic , a kind of noble serenity appears to pervade his countenance and action, which impresses respect. The Apostles, on the contrary, are in extreme agitation, and their attitudes and countenances are expressive of various emotions. Fear, love, anxiety, and a desire to pene- trate the full extent of our Saviour's meaning, are


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. xlvii

easily distinguishable in their looks and gestures. But when Leonardo wished to pourtray the character of the divinity on the figure and countenance of our Lord, his hand was too weak to represent the concep- tions of his mind, and whatever he executed was still very far from satisfying the sublimity and delicacy of his ideas. At length, despairing of success, he un- burthened his mind to his friend Bernardo Zenale,* who, not believing that he could surpass what he had already done, advised him to leave the head of Christ unfinished. Leonardo, after much consideration, re- solved to follow his friend's counsel : in imitation of Timanthes, of whom it is related, that in his picture of the Sacrifice of Iphigenia, having employed every possible expression of grief in the attendants, he con- ceived he could not do more justice to the fathers feelings, who was to behold the sacrifice of his own child, than by covering his face with his mantle, and leaving the effect to the beholder's imagination.f

Nothing can be more impressive than the idea of the impossibility of representing our Saviour's countenance by human means ; and this very imperfection becomes a greater beauty in a country ^where one is too much accustomed to see the Deity represented, or rather misrepresented, in all sorts of extraordinary and fan- tastic forms, in the old frescoes and mosaics. J

  • This painter and architect was a native of Treviso, and was

working at the same time as Leonardo in the Convent of the " Madonna delle Grazie." Lomazzo mentions him as the author of a treatise on Perspective, of which he had a thorough know- ledge. See Lomazzo Idea del Tempio della Pittura, book 5, chap. 21.

t Plin. lib. 35, cap. 10.

X As an example of the paintings alluded to, it is sufficient to


Xlviii THE LIFE OF

Having settled this difficulty, he found himself speedily embarrassed by another, which was to find a countenance sufficiently wicked to convey an idea of the man who was about to betray his divine master. This feeling, to one who was always in the habit of long reflection before he attempted any thing of con- sequence, greatly delayed his work, and gave rise to the story Vasari tells of the Prior of the Dominicans, who became impatient whenever he saw Leonardo in contemplation instead of continuing his picture ; he being one of those who imagine that a painter must be neglecting his work whenever his hands are not actually employed on it. He therefore complained of Leonardo's indolence to the Duke, who, in order to satisfy him, inquired about the picture, and found that the artist never passed a day without working at it at least for two hours. Still, however, its progress did not keep pace with the Prior's impatience, who con- tinued to persecute the Duke with his complaints until he prevailed on him to send for Da V^inci, and remon- strate with him on his delay. But Ludovico did this with so much kindness and affability that Leonardo was quite charmed with the prince's condescension, and willingly explained to him, that a man of genius is, in fact, never less occupied than when he appears to be entirely so, particularly in painting, where so much depends on a just and proper conception of the subject. He concluded by telling the Duke, " There remain, Sir, only two heads unfinished in the whole

mention an old picture on wood of the Annunciation, in which the Almighty is represented as an old man looking in at the window, while the angel is delivering the divine message to the Virgin.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. xllX

picture. That of Christ I have long despaired of ever being able to complete, as I am quite convinced of the utter impossibility of finding a model on earth capable of representing the union of divinity with humanity, and much less can I hope to supply the deficiency from my own imagination. Nothing therefore is want- ing but to express the character of Judas, and I have for some time sought without success, among your prisons and the very refuse of the people, for a coun- tenance such as I require ; but if your Excellency is so impatient that the picture should be finished, I can take the likeness of the Dominican Prior, who richly deserves it for the impertinence of his interference." The Duke could not avoid laughing heartily at this sally, and being fully convinced how much labour and judgment Leonardo bestowed on each individual, was only impressed with a still greater respect for his talents. It may also be easily supposed that the fear of being handed down to posterity as Judas, effectually silenced the Prior's importunities.* Da Vinci, how- ever, was a man of too much honour to have had any idea of putting his threat in execution, as has been erroneously asserted } besides which, the Prior of the Dominicans is described by the writers of that period as having too noble an appearance for such a purpose. Some little time after, Leonardo found a face such as he required, so that by adding something from his imagination, he finished the head of Judas, completed his picture, and excelled all his former productions. In this wonderful composition, which was then con-

  • This story is to be found in Bottari's " Lettere Pittoriche,"

and its truth is confirmed by Vasari and several of Leonardo da Vinci's contemporaries.


1 THE LIFE OF*

sidered almost a miracle of human perfection, Leo- nardo derived the greatest assistance from his previous studies. These he found a perfect treasure of intel- ligence to him ; and, whenever he was at a loss for any particular trait of countenance, he had recourse to his tablets, and there found ample reason to applaud his former industry ; for, as has before been ob- served, he never lost an opportunity of drawing every remarkable countenance that he could meet with. This he considered to be of such utility, that he always carried a small sketch-book in his girdle, in which he drew whatever made the most impression on his ima- gination 3 and he advised all artists to do the same. It was his opinion that nature was the best teacher ; and for that reason he obliged his scholars to delineate the most extraordinary as well as the most beautiful features they could meet with, which he considered the best means of taking good likenesses. Had he entertained any doubt of the usefulness of this system, the assistance he derived from it in his great work of " The Last Supper," where he had so many different feelings and passions to pourtray, would have been sufficient to confirm his opinion.

This inimitable picture has been so frequently de- scribed, and so universally eulogised, that there is little which is new to be said upon the subject, and any description of that painting would be superfluous after the beautiful engraving made from it by the Chevalier Raphael Morghen. It therefore only re- mains to join in the general regret excited by its too speedy decay, which has deprived the world of what formed the glory of Da Vinci, and the wonder of the age in which he lived. As far back as the middle of


LEONARDO DA VINCI.


H


sixteenth century, Armenini speaks of this picture as halt' destroyed : if we may believe Da Vinci's friend and scholar Lomazzo, who frequently mentions it in his Treatise, the colours soon disappeared, so that the outlines only remained to indicate the excellence of the drawing. In the early part of the seventeenth century, both Cardinal Borromeo and Padre Gattico, who resided some time in the Dominican Convent at Milan, agree in saying of this picture, " che del Ce- nacolo vedeansi solo le reliquiej" and that from its continually mouldering away, copies had been taken of it in all sizes by most of the celebrated artists of that time, and which are now dispersed throughout Italy.* In 1624, Bartolomeo Sanese, who saw both the original and the famous copy in the Chartreuse Convent of Pavia, by Marco Oggioni, declared that more praise was due to the Chartreuse than the Do- minicans ; as, while Leonardo's own work was so


  • The following is the most authentic list of the ancient copies

still extant : —

1. In the Franciscan Convent at Milan, by Lomazzo, in 1561.

2. In St. Barnabas, a small copy by Marco Oggioiii.

3. At St. Peter's, a copy by Santagostino.

4. In the Grand Monastery, by Lomazzo.

5. In the Public Library, done by order of Cardinal Borromeo.

6. In the Monastery of the Jesuits, two miles from Milan, by Oggioni.

7. In the Grand Chartreuse at Pavia, by the same.

8. At St. Benedetto, at Mantua, by Monsignori.

9. At Lugano, by Bernardino Luino.

10. In Spain, at the Escurial, by Luino.

11. In France, at St. Germain's, painted by Luino, by order of Francis the First.

12. At Ecoens, painter unknown.


Hi


THE LIFE OF


much destroyed by age and damp as to be scarcely discernible, the copy would be the mean? of handing it down to the admiration of posterity. The picture became gradually so much worse, that Scannelli, who saw it in 1642, observes, that ♦' There are but few vestiges remaining of the figures ; and the naked parts, such as heads, hands, and feet, are almost entirely annihilated." This is the only excuse the Dominicans could possibly have for cutting off the feet of our Saviour and several of the Apostles near him, in order to enlarge their entrance into the refectory. Nothing but the extreme decay of the picture itself could palliate so senseless an act ; and it is most probable that it remained in this neglected state until 1726, when the painter, Bellotti, succeeded in cleaning and restoring it so well that it appeared to revive, and almost to regain its former beauty. Many writers assert that Bellotti simply repainted it on Da Vinci's outlines ; but this is denied by his contemporaries, and Padre Pino assures us that he " made the picture revive by some secret of his own, retouching with the point of his brush only those places where the colour was quite peeled off."

Notwithstanding Bellotti's labours to preserve this painting, it soon began to lose its newly acquired beauty, and to peel otF and moulder away in such a manner that the Abbate Luigi Lanzi, in his celebrated work of the " Storia Pittorica dell' Italia," observes, that there were only three heads in the whole picture that could be considered as Leonardo's painting. However, it remained tolerably discernible until the Dominicans themselves were driven out of their Con- vent when the French army invaded Italy under Na-


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. lui

poleon. The Convent was then used as a cavahy depot, and the refectory turned into a stable ; so that the brutah'ty of the soldiery soon completed what the ignorance of the priesthood and the ravages of time had commenced. With a spirit of destruction scarcely to be accounted for, the troops of republican France had no hesitation in firing at our Saviour and all the Apostles, leaving more proofs of their skill as marks- men than of their feelings as Christians or civilized beings.

It is now so much destroyed that it is even a matter of dispute whether it was originally painted in oil, fresco, or tempera. That it was done in oil is most probable, from it always having been said so in the earliest engravings, and spoken of as such in contem- poraneous writings, and also from its speedy decay, there being rarely an instance of the durability of oil painting upon walls. Many authors pretend that the colours faded so soon from Da Vinci's having made use of some particular varnish or chemical preparation, as he was always considered too fond of experiments. Had Leonardo been merely a painter, he would have been contented with the usual methods of painting; but his lofty genius and love of new inventions tended on this, as on many other occasions, to eclipse his fame ; for, had it been otherwise, this great work might have been spared to the present age. Much of the destruction which this picture has suffered must doubtless be attributed to bad restoration ; and con- siderable allowances should be made for the envy of his contemporaries.

We may endeavour to trace the progress of its decay, as the only consolation which remains to us for


liv THE LIFE OF

such a loss ; and when we consider the time in which it was executed, it must be allowed to have been one of the greatest works of art ever undertaken. Ra- phael's " School of Athens," is considered by some as a work of greater merit ; but it should be recollected that a number of years had elapsed between the paint ing of these two pictures, and that great progress had been made in the arts during that period. Besides, it is scarcely just to Leonardo da Vinci that Raphael should claim superiority from having profited by the improvements which his predecessor had introduced. It is a curious coincidence that the two invasions of Italy by the French should have been equally detri- mental to Da Vinci's two great works, although so many centuries intervened between them ; as Monsig- nore Sabba da Castiglione, a noble Milanese, tells us in his " Ricordi," that " he saw the bowmen of Gas- cony make use of Da Vinci's model for the colossal statue of Francesco Sforza as a target," and many noble Milanese of the present day could tell us in their "ricordi," that they saw the troops of republican France make a somewhat similar use of his magnificent picture of " The Last Supper."

In 1497, Ludovico's wife, Beatrice of Este, died after a short illness, and the Duke honoured her me- mory, according to Coi'io, with a " stupendissime ossequie." From several notes in his tablets we find that these were directed by Leonardo, which affords an additional proof of his patron's confidence.

It was about this time that he became acquainted with Andrea Salaj'no, whom he received into his stu- dio, and soon admitted to his intimate friendship. He had the greatest regard for this young man, and look


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Iv

great pleasure in teaching him every thing relating to painting ; in which he acquired such proficiency, that some of his works in Milan have been falsely attri- buted to Leonardo. The probability is, that some of them were corrected by him, or had the advantage of receiving his finishing touches. Salaj'no was so grate- fully attached to his master, that he never quitted him from that period, and was the constant companion and sharer of his fortunes.

Da Vinci's principal occupation during this year was the navigation of the Adda, between Brizzio and Frezzo. This was a most difficult undertaking, from the rapidity of the stream, and the numerous shoals which impeded its progress, and obliged him to ex- cavate a new canal, and form strong supports to pre- vent the banks from falling in. From different cir- cumstances we may believe that he formed plans to overcome all these difficulties, though it does not appear that they M'ere carried into effect at that period, as the political troubles which embarrassed his patron obliged him to put a sudden termination to many of the works of art which he had previously undertaken.

It is not known that Leonardo painted any thing of consequence subsequent to his grand work of " The Last Supper," before the misfortunes of the house of Sforza obliged him to return to his own country, ex- cept another portrait of the beautiful Cecilia Galler- ani, on wood, which is at present in the possession of the Palavicini family at San Calocero,

The greatest mortification to Leonardo was his being obliged to abandon all idea of finishing the equestrian statue of Francesco Sforza, which was to have been cast in bronze, and had already occupied


Ivi THE LIFE OF

him so many years. His mould was prepared, and nothing was wanting but the metal, which the Duke was no longer able to furnish, as, according to Da Vinci's own calculation, it would have taken 200,000 pounds weight of bronze. In vain did Leonardo solicit his friends to use their utmost influence with the Duke ; in vain did the poets of the court endeavour to flatter him into acquiescence with Da Vinci's wishes ; Ludovico no longer had it in his power to expend money on the fine arts, but was obliged to employ the little that remained in his own defence.

Da Vinci's situation must now have been extremely unpleasant, as it appears from a fragment of one of his own letters, that the Duke owed him more than two years' salary. He must have been in great pecuniary embarrassment before his pride would have permitted him to have written " that he was no longer able to continue his works at his own expense, as he had not the means either of paying his workmen or purchasing his materials." It must have been a most bitter dis- appointment to him to have found his time so thrown away, as he could no longer entertain any hope of making his cast of this statue, on which he had be- stowed so much labour, and from which he had ex- pected to have derived so much fame. His enemies assert that his design was too grand and speculative to have been ever carried into effect ; but great allow- ances should be made for the envy excited by his talents and success at the court of Milan.

It appears, however, from several memoranda in his own hand-writing, that Leonardo himself not only considered it possible, but had made his calculations with the greatest nicety, and would have, no doubt.


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. Mi

succeeded in his undertaking, had not the political events of the times put it entirely out of his power.

In the following year, 1495, the Duke gave Leo- nardo a proof of his friendship and generosity, by making him a present of a small estate near the Porta Vercellina, with full power to bequeath it to whom he pleased, or to dispose of it in any way he thought proper.* Whether this land was given as a compensa- tion for the arrears that were justly his due, or as a gift for services received by the state, is immaterial ; most probably the Duke wished to avert as much as possible the want and misery to which he feared Da Vinci would be exposed in the event of his own ruin, as he had been exclusively employed for the benefit of the house of Sforza and the government of Milan. It is a proof, however, of II Moro's goodness of heart, that he could remember the wants of his friends when pur- sued on all sides by his enemies. Shortly after he was forced to fly from the city.

The flight of his patron, and the subsequent change in the government of Milan, must have caused the greatest regret to Da Vinci and his friends, who had equal reason to lament his fate as a prince and an in-

  • This gift is registered in the public office at Milan as fol-

lows : —

" 1429, 26 Aprilis, Ludovicus Maria Sfortia, dux Mediolani, done dcdit D. Leonardo Quintio (sic) Florentio, pictori celeber- rinio, pert. n. 16 soli seu fundi ejus vinae quam ab Abate seu Monasterio S. Victoris in suburbano porta; Vercellinse proxime acquisierat, ut in eo spatio soli pro ejus arbitrio aedificare, colere hortos, et quicquid ei vel posteris ejus, vel quibus dederit ut supra, libuerit, facere et disponere possit." — Copied verbatim from the Register.


Iviii THE LIFE OF

dividual, as they were all obliged to him for the means of continuing their studies and exercising their talents. He had been their patron and friend j and although his enemies accuse him of having encouraged the fine arts solely from ostentation, the greatest praise is due to him for the manner in which he promoted general knowledge. His worth must have also been more appreciated by his literary friends when brought into comparison with their new masters ; for Louis the Twelfth, after he had made his grand entry into Milan, thought of nothing but fetes and entertainments during the time he remained there ; and the French in general were extremely indifferent to the progress of literature and the arts. They destroyed a magnificent building which Leonardo had designed for Galeazzo da San Severino, and wantonly broke up his model for the equestrian statue, both of which must have caused him great mortification.

Finding his talents neglected, himself unrewarded, and his works no longer esteemed, without any imme- diate prospect of his former patron's re-establishment in Milan, Leonardo determined to leave a city where his finances were so much reduced, and his situation so unpleasantly altered. It appears, however, that he delayed his departure until the year 1500, and that he waited the issue of II Moro's return to Milan at the request of his faithless subjects, when they revolted against the French. Hoping to maintain himself by force, the ex-Duke raised a body of Swiss mercenaries, who, instead of fighting in his defence, basely sold him to his enemies, by whom he was taken in disguise with his brother the Cardinal Ascanio, and several of his followers. II Moro was imprisoned in the castle of


LEONARDO DA VIXCI. Ixix

Loches, in France, where he died of a broken heart at the unhappy issue of all his wild dreams of ambition, after ten years' confinement.

During the uncertainty of this revolution, while awaiting the result ofhispatron's laststruggleforpower, Da Vinci remained at Vaprio,* to be out of the way of the cabals and disturbances of the capital. This would have given him an opportunity of studying the source of the Adda, which had always been a favourite object of his researches. Or perhaps he lingered behind in hopes of seeing Milan again restored to tranquillity, and the love for the arts revived in a place where he had so highly distinguished himself. He must also have been extremely unwilling to lose the fruits of his long services to this state, as he considered himself attached to the court of Milan, whatever sovereign might be at the head of that government. But, per- ceiving at length that the French thought of nothing but their amusements, he made uj) his mind to return to his own country ; and shortly after, accompanied by his friends Salaj'no and Luca Paciolo, set out for Florence, where he resolved to take up his residence, and hoped to find emploj'ment.

In the mean time the government of Florence had passed into other hands, and had undergone an almost

  • The Melzi Villa, at Vaprio, is half-way hetwwen Milan and

Bergamo, on the canal of the Martesana, which was the work of Leonardo, and which, as well from its utility as from the diffi- culties he surmounted in its execution, would have been sufficient to immortalize his memory. The situation was extremely plea- sant, and this place was a great favouiite with Da Vinci, who frequently retired there.


Ix THE LIFE OF

entire change. Disgusted with the arrogance and imbecility of Pietro dei Medici's conduct, his fellow- citizens had revolted from his sway, and banished him and his whole family, declaring them enemies to the state. They had elected Pietro Soderini, one of their principal citizens, as their Lord, with the title of " Gonfaloniere Perpetuo," and the city was now en- joying more tranquillity than it had experienced since the death of Lorenzo the Magniticent. The immense wealth produced by their extensive commerce enabled the Florentines to cultivate the fine arts, and adorn their city with public buildings, notwithstanding the miseries and disturbances occasioned by the perpetual struggles of contending parties to obtain a preponder- ance in the government of the state. Their patriotism and public spirit overcame every difficulty, and the pride of all was interested in enriching their country with works of art, and in giving employment to the first artists of the age.

Leonardo da Vinci was received with every distinc- tion by the Gonfiiloniere, who immediately enrolled him in the list of those artists who were employed by the government, and assigned him a sufficient pension to provide for his subsistence, which enabled him to form a tolerably comfortable establishment, with his friend Paciolo and his scholar Salajno. On the subject of this pension, Vasari relates the following anecdote.

" Leonardo was very high-minded, and extremely generous in all his actions. It is said that, going one day to the bank for the monthly provision that he was accustomed to receive from Pietro Soderini, the cashier wanted to give him some bundles of halfpence,


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixi

which he refused, saying, I am not a halfpenn}- painter."*

It is a great pity that Da Vinci allowed his pride to have so much ascendency over his better judgment. His irritable sensibility was his greatest enemy through life, and was the occasion of his losing many friends, who had both the power and inclination to assist him. This prevailing foible was also extremely detri- mental to his fame in his profession, as it frequently blinded him to the difficulties of executing the vast conceptions of his all-comprehensive mind. His bril- liant imagination made him suppose that every thing must give way to his abilities, and led him into errors which have deprived posterity of some of his best works. His ideas were too gigantic for the age in which he lived, and it would have been much better for his reputation as a painter if he had been a less universally accomplished man.

After his return to Florence, he pursued his studies with unremitting assiduity, and diligently worked at his profession, which he was the more obliged to attend to from no longer having the advantage of so good a salary as he had enjoyed at Milan. Instead of the luxuries and extravagances of II Moro's splendid court, he had now to accommodate hiwjself to the more prudent restrictions of a republic, whose slmp- tuary laws were enacted in a spirit of economy quite different to what he had seen at Milan.


  • " lo non sono un dipintore per quatrini." The quatrino is

translated in the text as a halfpenny, to make it the more intel- ligible ; its real value is the fifth part of a grazia, which is the eighth of a franc, valued at G^d. English.

d .


Ixii THE LIFE OF

The first work of consequence in which he was en- gaged, was an altar-piece for the church of the " Annunziata." Unfortunately, however, he only formed the design of this picture, which is generally called the Cartoon of Santa Anna, which was so ex- quisitely finished, that Vasari says, " not only all the artists, but the whole city, men and women, young and old, flocked to see it in such crowds, that for two days it had almost the appearance of a public festival," The same author describes the artist's having suceess- fully expressed in the countenance of the Virgin Mary " all the grace which simplicity and beauty could pos- sibly give to the mother of Christ, anxious to show the modesty, humility, and thankfulness, which she might be supposed to feel in contemplating the beauty of her child, which she is supporting in her lap ; while she is looking down at St. John, a little boy playing with a kid, encouraged by the smiles of Santa Anna, who is delighted to see her terrestrial progeny thus become almost celestial." •* A consideration," he further observes, " truly worthy of Leonardo's talents and genius." This picture was carried to France in the time of Francis the First ; but it must have found its way back to Italy, as it belonged to Aurclio Luino, when Lomazzo wrote his Treatise on Painting.

About this time Da Vinci applied himself more par- ticularly to portraits, and painted two of the most celebrated beauties of Florence ; the Lady Ginevra, wife of Amerigo Benci, which, according to Vasari, was " una cosa bellissima," and the Madonna Lisa, wife of Francesco del Giocondo, which all the artists and writers of that period considered as the perfection of portrait-painting. Vasari describes this picture in so


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixiii

very minute and lively a nnanner, that it is impossible to give a more accurate description of it, than by making use of his own words, written on the spot shortly after it was finished : " In this head the be- holder may observe how nearly it is possible for art to approach nature. The eyes have the lustre and ex- pression of life. The nose, and more particularly the mouth, have more the appearance of real flesh and blood than painting, from the beautiful contrast of the Vermillion of the lips with the clear red and white of the complexion. Whoever attentively looks at the throat, can almost see the beating of the pulse. As the Madonna Lisa was a very beautiful woman, Leo- nardo studied all possible means of making her picture surpass every thing that had been then seen of the sort. He was in the habit of having music, singing, and all kinds of buffoonery to make her laugh and re- move the air of melancholy so frequently to be observed in portrait-painting; which produced so pleasing an effect in this picture, that it gave to the canvass an almost superhuman expression, and the only wonder seemed to be that it was not alive."

Francis the First bought this picture for his collec- tion at Fontainbleau, and paid 4000 gold crowns to the family for whom it was painted, a sum that would be equal to 45,000 francs in the present day. It is now in the Louvre, and is considered one of the finest specimens of Leonardo's painting extant; it is called " La belle Joconde," and there is a landscape in the back-ground.

After remaining two years at Florence, Da Vinci travelled over the greater part of Italy, and made notes and drawings of whatever he found instructive d2


Ixiv THE LIFE OF

and amusing. It would have been highly interesting to have had an opportunity of collecting the remarks of a traveller so perfectly capable of describing what- ever he saw, and who united in himself the different qualifications of a painter, mechanic, and architect, with the philosophical feelings of a liberal-minded man. He must have visited the whole of Romagna, as we find from his notes he was at Urbino on the 30th July, 1502, where he designed the fortress. He went to Pesaro, Rinucci, and Cesena, where he remarks

  • ' the picturesque manner in which the vines were sus-

pended in festoons." It would have been difficult to have assigned a reason for his having consumed his time and money in travelling, if it were not sufficiently explained by the fact of the Duca Valentino's having appointed him his surveyor and engineer general, as that would have obliged him to visit all the strong places, of which the Duke had usurped the dominion as Gonfaloniere or Captain-General of the ecclesias- tical army. The immoderate ambition of the house of Borgia was, in this instance, of material service to Leonardo, enabling him to see more of his country than he had hitherto done, without any expense to himself J as it is well known that, whatever were Valen- tino's vices, he was, either from policy or ostentation, liberal even to excess to those who were in his service. Pope Alexander the Sixth died 18th August, 1503, in the seventy-first year of his age, a victim, it is sup- posed, to his own treacherous intrigues, as he is said to have taken a goblet of poisoned wine which he had prepared for one of his guests. This circumstance destroyed all the brilliant projects of the house of Borgia, and occasioned the sudden downfall of Valen- tino and his dependents. He was succeeded by Julius


LEONARDO DA VINCI. IxV

the Second, whose wisdom and integrity partly in- demnified Christendom for the profligate enormities by which his predecessor had disgraced the pontificate. The Pope's death also speedily terminated Da Vinci's commission, as in 1503 we find him returned to Flo- rence, and engaged to paint one side of the council- hall in the Palazzo Vecchio, by the desire of the Gon- faloniere Pietro Soderini.

This was the origin of all the jealousies and disputes between Leonardo da Vinci and Michael Angelo Buo- narroti, who had also been employed to make designs for the same purpose ; and hence arose a rivalry be- tween these two great men which caused them to exert their utmost abilities in the cartoons they respec- tively executed. As these paintings were intended as a sort of national monument, it was necessary to select some trait in the Florentine history, which might at once serve to commemorate the glory of the republic and the fame of the painter. From a long memoran- dum in Leonardo's handwriting, we find that he had chosen for his subject the defeat of Nicolo Picinino, the Milanese General, near Anghiari, in Tuscany, and that he had collected every circumstance of this battle, either real or fictitious, in order to delineate it pro- perly. We can easily perceive from his remarks the labour he must have bestowed on collecting materials for this picture, which, it is much to be regretted, was never executed, as Vasari relates that having tried his preparations on the wall, for painting it in oil, he found it did not succeed, and therefore abandoned the undertaking altogether.* Here is another instance of

  • The memorandum for this picture is given in Brown's Life

(Appendix, No. III.), from Leonardo's manuscript. It is curious


Ixvi THE LIFE OF

his versatility of talent interfering with his fame as a painter ; for, had he been entirely ignorant of che- mistry, he would necessarily have been obliged to content himself with the ordinary rules of fresco paint- ing, and he might again have left a work that would have immortalized his name.

As these cartoons no longer exist, a description of them may prove interesting. Vasari tells us that Leo- nardo represented a combat of horsemen fighting for a standard, which group was only intended as a part of the historical design just alluded to. It was so wonderfully executed, that the horses themselves seemed agitated with the same fury as their riders, and were fighting as hard with their teeth as their riders with their swords, to obtain possession of the contested flag. " Neither is it possible," continues Vasari, " to describe Leonardo's designs, in the soldiers' dresses so beautifully varied, as well as in the incredible skill he showed in the forms and attitudes of the horses, as no other artist could delineate the muscles and actions of the horse with such uncommon beauty and fide- lity." * Michael Angelo's cartoon represented a troop of soldiers suddenly called to arms when bathing, and the scene of his picture was the siege of Pisa by the Florentines, and has been so fully described by Mr. Duppa in his Life of that great artist, that it need not be here repeated. Both these cartoons were shown

to observe the minute details he entered into in his compositions, and with what extreme accuracy lie studied to increase the in- terest of his historical performances.

  • One part of Leonardo's cartoon was engraved by Marc An-

tonio, the other by Agostino Veneziano. The former is called

  • ' Les grimpeurs," and both are exceedingly rare.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixvii

in the Medici palace until the death of the Duke Giuliano, when they disappeared without any person being able to account for it. Vasari says that Michael Angelo's was torn in pieces, and that in his time there was a small piece, remaining in the hands of a dillet- tante at Mantua, It may be supposed in what esteem they must have been held, when their fame was suffi- cient to induce Raphael to come to Florence for the sole purpose of studying them. Pie was so much sur- prised and delighted at their freedom of manner and boldness of execution, that from that moment he is said to have resolved to abandon the stiffness and po- verty of his master Pietro Perugino's style.

During his stay in Tuscany, Leonardo renewed his former friendship with Giovan Francesco Rustici,* who had been his fellow-student with Andrea Varoc- chio when they were both young men. Rustici was a man of good family, and more an artist from inclin- ation than necessity. He had the good taste to listen to Da Vinci's criticism, to whom he was particularly attached; and was also well acquainted with the worth of his observations. He was esteemed a good sculp- tor and architect by his contemporaries, as well as by his friend Leonardo ; and the three statues which he cast in bronze for the baptistery at Florence, remain to this day memorials of his fame.

In 1504< Leonardo da Vinci lost his father, with whom he had always continued on the most affectionate

• Giovan Francesco Rustici was a man of a very extraordinary turn of mind ; he became the founder of a society or club called the Pajuolo, of which the account, given by Vasari, is very illus- trative of the manners of the times.


Ixviii THE LIFE OF

terms. Whatever might have been his birth, he had made a point of keeping up a constant correspondence and perfectly good understanding with his family. It appears that soon after the Signore Pietro's death, he placed a considerable sum of money at interest with the chamberlain of Santa Maria Nuova, as there are several memoranda among his papers of his having received small payments at different times from this person, and he afterwards disposed of this particular property in his will. From this we may suppose that some of his works had been very liberally rewarded, as this money could only have been acquired by his own exertions. It is .Ammoretti's opinion that he visited France in 1506, but there is not sufficient proof of his having undertaken that journey, in the several memoranda on which this gentleman hazards his assertion ; for they might have as easily referred to his subsequent residence in that country, although he certainly considered himself in the service of the King of France as sovereign of Milan. In whatever way he employed the intermediate time, it is certain that Leonardo was again in Lombardy in 1507, as there is the following memorandum in his own handwriting : " Canonica di Vaprio, a di 5 Luglio 1507, cara mia diletta Madre et mia Sorella et mia Cognata avvissovi come sono sano per la grazia di Dio," &c. ; which sufficiently proves the fact of his having been staying at that time with his friends the Melzi. That he was frequently in the habit of residing with them, not only

it their house at Canonica, but also at their palace at

Vaprio, there remains a proof as glorious to the artist's i'eelings as to his generous patrons, in the picture of ihe Madonna and Child which he painted on the wall


LEONARDO DA VTXCI. Ijdx

of his apartment in their palace. The head of the Madonna is six palms in height, and that of the Child four. This painting suflFered considerably in 1796, by some soldiers having made a fire close to the wall on which it is executed ; but the faces are still in toler* able preservation.

In 1507 Louis the Twelfth of France, finding him- self continually disturbed in the possession of his Lombard dominions by the Venetians and the States of the Church, joined the famous league of Cambray, that he might be at more liberty to invade Italy with a sufficient force to establish his affairs on a firmer bas's of political security. At Agnadello, near the Adda, the King gained a complete victory over the Venetians, and returned to Milan to celebrate his triumphs and revive the drooping spirits of its inha- bitants by the presence of his splendid court. These fetes and entertainments must have again called forth Leonardo's exertions, for they are described with great pomp by Arluno, in a manuscript now in the Ambro- sian Library, who talks of the triumphal arches and paintings executed by the first masters in honour of the occasion. Although he does not mention Leo- nardo da Vinci's name, he evidently alludes to him by his making use of the phrase " pitture mollissime," which that author was accustomed to apply to him alone. Besides which, it is well known that he was in great favour with his Majesty at that time, as he appointed him painter to the court of France, and gave him twelve ounces of water from the canal of the Mar- tesana, which was a sort of right of property extremely valuable to its possessor. As far as this gift can be at present understood, it appears that he was entilled (15


IXX THE LIFE OF

to as much water as could be drawn off by a tunnel that measured one foot in diameter, which is equal to twelve ounces, and that he had the right of applying this to whatever purpose he pleased. To an engineer of his talents this was of the greatest value, as he might have either applied it to hydraulical purposes, or sold it to the proprietors of the neighbouring lands to enrich the cultivation of their soil by its irrigations. By his letters from Florence it would appear that he intended making the former use of it, but the latter would also have yielded him a handsome revenue. It is not likely that he ever realized this property, but he showed that he considered it belonged to him, by dis- posing of it in his will. While in attendance on the French court at Milan, he painted the portrait of Gian Jacopo Triulzio, which is mentioned by Lomazzo, and is now in the Public Gallery at Dresden.

The death of his uncle, Messer Francesco da Vinci, a share in whose inheritance his brothers contested with him, on the ground of his illegitimacy, determined him to go to Florence to settle the dispute. It is not known how the affair was determined between them, but we may be allowed to conjecture that it must have been in an amicable manner, from the circumstance of his leaving his property in and near Florence to be equally divided between his brothers at his death. In 1512 he returned to Milan, where he principally em- ployed himself in hydraulical researches, in order to perfect the canal by which he had brought the Adda to the walls of the city. But he was again destined to be interrupted in his professional occupations ; for he had scarcely time to see his friends, and get settled in his habitation, before the new government of Milan


LEONARDO DA VINCI. IxXl

was broken up, and the tranquillity of Lorabardy so much destroyed, that he was again obliged to seek refuge in a more peaceful quarter.

The Princes of Italy, jealous of the presence of a foreign army, whose power might become inimical to their interests, concluded a league with the Emperor to replace the house of Sforza on the throne of Lom- bardy. In a short time Maximilian, the eldest son of II Moro, returned in triumph to take undisputed pos- session of his paternal inheritance, escorted by the same Swiss mercenaries who had so shortly before betrayed his father. He was received with acclama- tions and rejoicings by the inhabitants of Milan. Leonardo himself, although belonging, as he con- ceived, to the court of France, was sufficiently attached to the remembrance of his old patron, to paint two portraits of the young Duke Maximilian, one of which is now in the Gallery of Milan, and the other in the private collection of the Melzi family. But the situa- tion of Milan, and the disturbed state of politics ia Italy, were so extremely detrimental to Da Vinci's projects, that he vvas almost unable to procure a sub- sistence by his profession. Between the two govern- ments he had already lost what he considered as a pro- vision for his old age, as he vvas now more than sixty, and no longer possessed that buoyant feeling and ardent disposition that carried him through every thing in youth. It was quite in vain for Leonardo, or any of his followers and companions in the Academy, to think of remaining in a place where nothing was to be expected but tumults and revenge. Literature and the fine arts are nurtured by peace and tranquillity alone : where these cease to exist, the artist who


Ixxii THE LIFE OF

desires to increase his reputation had better depart also. Accordingly, we find by the following memo- randum, that Leonardo at last set out for Rome, accompanied by his principal friends and scholars : ■" Partii da Milano per Roma ad di 24 di Settembre 1514, con Giovanni, Francesco Melzi, Salaj, Lorenzo ed il Fanfoia." *

Leonardo arrived in safety at Florence, where he found the power of the house of Medici restored by the election of the Cardinal Giovanni to the pontificate, under the name of Leo the Tenth, after the decease of Julius the Second. The Pope's brother, Giuliano de' Medici received him into his household and took him to Rome. Every individual possessed of either talents or reputation was then hastening to that capital to recommend himself to the notice of Leo the Tenth ; a pontiff whose name must ever be respected in the annals of literature and the arts, and whose princely liberality, by completing the restoration of learning, made Rome once more mistress of the civilized world. Although advanced in years, and the ardour of feel- ing considerably abated by the experience which can only be acquired from a knowledge of the world and its disappointments, Da Vinci yet hoped to distinguish himself amongst those who contended for the Pope's favour.

On his arrival he was well received by Leo, both from the high reputation he enjoyed, and the circum- stance of his being presented to the Pontiff by his brother

  • Probably this Giovanni means " il Beltraffio," but there is

no mention of any person called Fanfoia, unless it is a mistake for Fojano, who is frequently spoken of by Lomazzo and others in their manuscripts.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixxiii

Giuliano, whose favour da Vinci had completely gained. But his talents excited the envy of all those who surrounded his Holiness's person and had already secured his confidence, as they considered his ap- proach as a sort of invasion of what they had appro- priated to themselves as a right : so seldom can men of genius bear with any sort of competition. No one was more free from this unworthy feeling of envy than Leonardo himself; no one more anxious to do ample justice to the merits of others ; but, most deservedly, accustomed to hold the first place at Milan, and con- scious that many of the improvements in the arts which he now saw brought into use, were owing to his own inventions and to the improvements which he himself had introduced, he could not avoid feeling most acutely that he no longer possessed the same superiority over others which he had done in his youth. If he had given himself time to think, he would have been consolc^d by the reflection that this was the natural consequence of the progress of the arts, to which he, more than any other person, had eminentl}' contributed. Instead of feeling mortified at the prac- tice of the theory which he himself had first propa- gated, he ought to have rejoiced at its having met with the success which he had originally contemplated. But his bodily health was no longer equal to the energy of his mind, and his increasing infirmities made him more than usually irritable, for he had naturally too much pride to indulge any feelings of vanity.

Under these circumstances it was not to be expected that Da Vinci could have felt himself happily situated at Rome, Harassed by disappointments, his genius was overcast by the praises he heard on all sides


Ixxiv THE LIFE OP

bestowed on others, whom he could not have consi- dered in any way superior to himself. But they en- joyed a greater share of his Holiness's favour, and kept Leonardo in the back-ground by persuading the Pope that he embraced too many branches of science to be able to succeed in any, and that he was become much too speculative in his ideas to execute any work of importance. By these and similar calumnies, un- worthy their own fame, and prompted solely by jea- lousy, they contrived to keep Da Vinci without any employment worthy of his talent?.

Of all the celebrated persons who at that time orna- mented tlie court of Rome, RafFaelle enjoyed the greatest share of the Pope's confidence and esteem, although he was more considerably indebted to his predecessor Pope Julius the Second. That Pontiff first brought him into notice at the recommendation of his kinsman, Bramante da Urbino, who was then in his service, and employed him to paint a suite of rooms in the Vatican. He executed this commission with such extraordinary taste and skill, that the fres- coes he then painted are generally considered superior to any of his subsequent productions under the reign of Leo the Tenth.

The great Michael Angelo, who was also at Rome at that period, had not the good fortune to be so much distinguished by Leo as he had been by Julius, who was his friend and patron ; and it ought to be ob- served, in justice to the latter, that many of the great works, the whole praise of which has been unthink- ingly bestowed on Leo, more properly belonged to his predecessor, he having originally undertaken them, though Leo had the liberality and generosity to carry


LEONARDO DA VINCI. IxXV

them into effect. If Leonardo da Vinci had enjoyed the advantage of the protection of Julius the Second, he would, no doubt, have been in a much better situ- ation ; and had he employed that time in his service which lie lost during the disturbances at Milan, he would not only have been at the head of his profession as an artist, but his knowledge of military tactics, and his talents as an engineer, would have made him an invaluable acquisition to that warlike Pontiff.

The reign of Leo the Tenth forms so striking an era in Italian literature, that one is too apt to con- found him personally with the age in which he lived. Without at all wishing to deteriorate the good qualities which this magnificent Pontiff undoubtedly possessed, it appears from the history of those times, that the age contributed more to his elevation, than he did indivi- dually to the advancement of learning. Had Julius lived a few years longer, we should have talked of the Julian age of Rome, instead of " the golden days of Leo," and the advantages to mankind would have been much the same. The ruling principle of Leo's policy was the aggrandisement of the house of Medici ; and by simply following the taste of the age, and act- ing up to the spirit of the times, he could most easily attain his object, while he gratified his own taste for splendour by becoming the liberal patron of men of letters. It is easy to be generous, even to profusion, of what does not belong to us ; and few of St. Peters representatives have ever made a freer use of his patri- mony. Circumstances made Leo what he was, and unless he had abandoned the pontificate altogether he must have been talked and flattered into virtues which he might not have otherwise possessed. It is


IxXVi THE LIFE OF

certainly no proof of his discernment or good taste, that he either could not or did not appreciate the talents of Leonardo da Vinci sufficiently to fix him near his person ; while it is well known that he neg- lected those of Michael Angelo Buonarroti.

Leonardo, however, during his short stay in Rome was not altogether unemployed, as he painted a pic- ture for Messer Baldassare da Pescia, the Pope's da- tario (almoner), who seemed to have more feeling for his merits than his master. This picture was painted on wood, and represented a Holy Family, consisting of the Virgin and Child, with St. Joseph and St. John behind, in which group was a portrait of a young lady in full length, of singular beauty and noble features. De Pagave, in speaking of this picture, observes that, " although the Vincian style is perfectly discernible, it is evident that he had imitated RafFaelle in this com- position 5" and for this reason he probably chose to distinguish it by the monogram of his own name, that it might not be taken for the work of any other artist. The beautiful lady whose portrait he introduced in this picture, is supposed to be the Pope's sister-in-law, as it is very natural that Leonardo should have paid this compliment to his patron's wife, Giuliano de' Me- dici having just married Filiberta of Savoy. Whoever the lady might have been, the picture was so wonder- fully executed that it attracted the Pope's attention, and occasioned him to employ Da Vinci, old as he was, in preference to Raffaelle and Michael Angelo, in the execution of a work which afterwards became the cause of his disgrace and of his departure from Rome. Vasari relates the story, that Leonardo, with his usual love of experiments, began to distil different herb*


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixxvii

and oils to make a particular kind of varnish, and that some ill-natured persons told this to the Pope, who exclaimed, " Oh ! this man will never do any thing, for he begins to think of the end of his work before the commencement." This hasty remark was imme- diately repeated to Leonardo, who, already disgusted with his Holiness for having sent for Michael Angelo to Rome, with whom he was on bad terms, determined on leaving it.

It is not to be wondered at, that so high-minded a man as Leonardo should have been offended at such an observation. Conscious of his own merits, and in- dignant at the neglect with which he had been treated during his residence at the papal court, he could not do otherwise than resolve to quit a place where he had met with so many vexations, and seek another patron in spite of his age and infirmities. There is nothing to be collected, either from his notes or the manuscripts in the Ambrosian Library, to prove that he undertook any thing more of consequence at Rome, except some improvements he introduced in the mint for purifying and embellishing the Roman coin. Be- fore his misunderstanding with the Pope, he had most likely painted the fresco of the Virgin on the walls of St. Onofrio, of which nothing now remains; as well as several other pictures for various individuals, who still cherished his name, and were anxious to possess some specimen of his abilities.

It was most unworthy of Leo's character, as the great Maecenas of the whole Christian world, to have treated Leonardo da Vinci with so little consideration. If for no other reasons but his former works, long experi- ence, and great reputation, he should have received


Ixxviii THE LIFE OF

him with kindness. The extreme amiabihty of his manners towards all might have at least blunted the shafts of envy and ill-nature. That he was himself superior to such meanness, he had given a proof in the last picture he painted, where he had, in a great mea- sure, adopted the ease of Raffaelle's style, in addition to the exquisite softness and minute finishing of his own. It was no small compliment to Raffaelle that Leonardo, even in his old age, should have conde- scended to imitate him ; for in such a man it was con- descension to alter his style in imitation of any one. Although it would be impossible to deny that Raffaelle excelled Da Vinci in painting nearly as much as Michael Angelo did in sculpture, still it must be gener- ally allowed, that, if they were the greater artists, he was the greater man, without derogating from the high character of either. When we consider the state in which Leonardo da Vinci found the arts when he first engaged in painting as a profession, the improvements which he introduced, the scholars whom he educated, and the prejudices which he annihilated, we are all lost in admiration of his various merits. Even Michael Angelo and Raffaelle are obliged to him for a part of their glory ; because they first became the great men they were from studying his works. Raffaelle borrowed from him that almost divine giace, which Leonardo so well knew how to impart to the counte- nances he painted ; Michael Angelo took from him that daring style of drawing by which he astonished mankind; and if afterwards both surpassed him, they were nevertheless infinitely indebted to the advantages they derived from his original inventions. Yet, such is the ungrateful reward of talent in all times, this man


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixxix

was obliged to expatriate himself when more than seventy years of age !

The politics of Italy were now again becoming em- broiled. King Louis the Twelfth of France died on the first day of the year 1515, and he was succeeded by Francis the First. It was not to be supposed that a young King of only twenty-two years of age would feel inclined to submit quietly to the loss of his Italian dominions, particularly as he had assumed the title of Duke of Milan on his accession to the throne, both in right of his predecessor and of the Emperor's conces- sion of that duchy at the league of Cambray. Having concluded an advantageous peace with the King of England and the Archduke of Austria, afterwards Charles V., the young monarch advanced towards Italy, determined to make light of every difficulty. His successes induced Leo to incline towards an accommodation. Francis was already in possession of Pavia ; and his armies were proceeding with rapid strides to reconquer the whole of Lombardy.

These political events no sooner became public than Leonardo da Vinci resolved to profit by the successes of his former patrons, the French, in whose service he still considered himself He therefore set out for Pavia, where he was received by Francis with every mark of friendship. He soon became a great favourite with his Majesty, who delighted in his society and conversation ; and Da Vinci's spirits began to revive at again finding himself in a situation where all his excellent qualities were duly appreciated. He felt himself of the same consequence he had formerly been; and presiding over the revels and entertain- ments of a magnificent court, he exerted his utmost


IXXX THE LIFE OF

taste and skill to please his chivalrous patron aind his nobles.

It is supposed that the Lion, spoken of by Lomazzo, was contrived by Leonardo on this occasion to increase the pomp of some of the fetes given in honour of the King's successes. This piece of mechanism was so admirably contrived, that the lion walked of itself up to the King's throne, and threw open its body, which was filled with " fleurs de lis," in compliment to his Majest)^ This pageant is frequently mentioned by the writers of that period, when it was, no doubt, considered as a most wonderful invention.

Both the Pope and the King of France were ex- tremely desirous of an interview, and Bologna was fixed upon as the place where the congress should be held. The King came attended with very little pomp, and only a small part of his brilliant court, but among them was Leonardo da Vinci, who must have been highly gratified in being able to show himself to the Pope's followers as the friend and favourite of a powerful monarch, after having been almost compelled to quit Rome. To the young King his experience was doubtless of the greatest use in treating with so wary a politician as Leo ; and his general knowledge of Italy^ both in politics and literature, must have increased his favour with Francis, to whose interest he was now most firmly attached, and from that time


  • Among Leonardo's papers was found a design for the por-

trait of Signore Artus, under which is written, in his own hand, writing, " Ritratto diM. Artus, Maestro di Camera del Re Fran- cesco primo, nella Giunta con Papa Leon decimo," which fully proves that Da Vinci was present on that occasion.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixxxi

Leonardo considered himself as belonging to the French court. Conscious of his own deserts, Leonardo da Vinci felt as an insult what was merely the effect of an envious cabal ; but his sensitive mind was so deeply wounded, that he determined to abandon his country for ever, and establish himself at the court of France for the rest of his days. If his pride could have sub- mitted to prove his superior merit by his works, in- stead of showing that he was offended by leaving the court of Rome, there is every probability that he must have triumphed over his enemies and regained the Pontiff's favour. But most likely he considered himself too old to begin the struggle anew, and he was perhaps too proud to submit to a competition for fame in a country where he had for so many years held the first place, and which was so much indebted to his exertions for many of the advantages which she possessed in the fine arts. Another reason that must have naturally influenced him at his time of life, was the instability of the Italian courts, the disadvantages of which he had sufficiently experienced in the down- fall of the house of Sforza, and the continual changes of the government of Milan. By these circumstances he had lost all the fruits of his long services to that state during the best part of his life ; and even his reputation had considerably suffered by it, in the de- struction of his works. The equestrian statue of Francesco Sforza, which he was to have cast in bronze, and by which he hoped to have established his fame as a sculptor, never proceeded any further than the model, and even that was destroyed by the brutality of the soldiery. The evils of war and the miseries of civil dissension had dispersed his friends and scholars.


Ixxxii THE LIFE OF

and nothing remained of the Academy which he had founded, but the effects wliich it produced on the arts in laying a foundation for the improvement of painting, by which all subsequent artists have more or less benefited. The friends of his brighter days were all either dead or no longer able to struggle against the misfortunes which they had met with from the un- settled state of their country ; so that it was not to be wondered at that Da Vinci should have preferred sheltering himself under the protection of a powerful monarch who promised to provide most generously for the rest of his life, to the precarious subsistence which Italy could afford him.

Previous to his departure from Milan, the King tried every means in his power to remove the painting of " The Last Supper," in order to send it to France. Every thing was done to deprive Milan of this magnifi- cent work which she has so badly taken care of j but it was found impracticable, although Francis would have spared no expense to have succeeded in his designs, and Leonardo did all in his power to gratify his new patron. However, all their efforts were ineffectual, and, as Vasari says, " the picture having been done immediately on the wall, his Majesty was obliged to depart with his wish ungratified, and leave the paint- ing to the Milanese." *

About the end of January 1516 Leonardo accom- panied Francis the First to Paris, as painter to the court of France, with an annual salary of 700 crowns, and a liberal provision for all his wants ; where he met with a reception equal to his merits. The King

  • An excellent copy of the Last Supper was purchased in Italy

by Sir Thomas Lawrence, and is now at the Royal Academy.


LEONARDO DA VINCI. Ixxxiii

treated him with distinguished favour, and the cour- tiers vied with each other in following his Majesty's example.

From the time of his arrival in France, his health began to deteriorate, so much so, that he was incap- able of applying himself to any thing of consequence. It is known from the direction of a letter found among his papers, " A Monsieur Lyonard Peintre, par Ara- boise," that he must have been at that place; as also from the circumstance of his will being dated from thence, in which he speaks of the furniture and valuables he possessed at " Du Cloux," about a mile from Amboise, where he most likely resided.

It does not appear probable that he painted any thing in France, as Vasari tells us that the King himself could not prevail on him to finish his cartoon of Santa Anna, which he had brought from Italy, and which was afterwards painted by some of his scholars on his outlines. It is also most likely that Leonardo, finding himself growing old, and much oppressed with sick- ness, would not have wished to undertake any work that he no longer felt himself able to complete without almost compromising his former reputation. We may therefore suppose that the painting of Francis's mistress, " La belle Furoniere," is the work of some of his scholars.

Towards the latter end of his life, Leonardo's health was so much broken, that his infirmities no longer permitted him to take any part in the pleasures of the world, and he began to prepare himself for that awful change which he expected to be soon called upon to make. Vasari tells us, that believing himself near death. Da Vinci devoted the remamder of his days to


Ixxxiv THE LIFE OF

a more strict observance of the precepts of the Ca- tholic religion ; which would almost imply that he had lived the greater part of his life without any. But this inference is strongly contradicted by the morality and propriety of his general conduct. For although his person, talents, and accomplishments would have given him every probability of success, particularly when united with the example of a most libertine court, it is well known there was no man of his time less addicted to gallantry and intrigue. His writings also are all of a more serious nature than could have been expected from the vivacity of his disposition in early life. And even his paintings are entirely free from any sort of lascivious or indecent ideas. He seldom painted naked figures ; but whenever he did undertake such subjects, they were always remarkable for the purity and mo- desty of their attitudes ; as in the Leda, which is men- tioned by Lomazzo, where he painted the eyes cast down from shame. Vasari must, therefore, have in- tended to express a total abandonment of the present to fix his mind exclusively on the future, rather than to insinuate any want of religion in his youth. Na- turally enthusiastic in his feelings, he turned his thoughts to his Maker with the same ardour which had distinguished him in all his actions ; and his death was as glorious as his life had been virtuous and useful. Having accompanied the court to Fontainbleau, he expired in the arms of Francis the First, who came to visit him during his illness, and happened by accident to be with him when he was seized with a mortal paroxysm that speedily terminated his existence. What a triumph to the arts ! and what an honour to the King! who had the pleasing remembrance of


LEONARDO DA VINCI. IxXXV

having comforted the last moments of one of the greatest artists that had then enlightened the world ; and Francis must have looked back with more real satisfaction and self-approbation, to the recollection of his having supported and soothed Leonardo da Vinci in the hour of death, than to many of the more brilliant events of his reign. If at such a moment, when all artificial distinctions are at an end, Leonardo could have entertained one worldly thought, it must have alleviated his sufferings and encouraged his hopes, to know that he breathed out his soul in the arms of one of the greatest monarchs in Europe, who, while livincr, regarded him with the warmest admira- tion, and when dying lamented him with the sincerest regret.

Such was the enviable fate of Leonardo da Vinci, who died at the age of seventy-five, universally esteemed and as universally regretted. His whole life was spent in advancing the happiness of his fellow- creatures by furthering the progress of science. Few men have done more good in the world : a generous patron, an affectionate friend, and a liberal-minded man, he was as ready to promote the views of others as he was to acknowledge their merit ; and he had scarcely a wish beyond the advancement of general knowledge and the encouragement of the fine arts.

Several authors, and among others Ammoretti, attempt to deprive Leonardo of the honour of having died in the arms of Francis, which they treat as a fic- titious story invented to amuse the lovers of the mar- vellous; but it is too well confirmed by contemporary writers and general tradition to be destroyed by these sceptics. We have, moreover, the testimony of Va- e


IXXXVl THE LIFE OP

sari, who relates the circumstance in these words : — " At length, seeing himself near death, he confessed himself with much contrition ; and although he was unable to stand, he desired his friends and servants to support him, that he might receive the holy sacrament out of bed in a more reverent posture. When fatigued with this exertion, the King came to visit him, and Leonardo, raising himself up in his bed out of respect to his Majesty, began to relate the circumstances of his illness, and the wrongs he had done both to God and man, by not making better use of his talents. In the midst of this conversation he was seized with a paroxysm, which proved the messenger of death 3 on seeing which, the King hastened to assist him, and supported him in his bed, in order to alleviate his suf- ferings. But his divine spirit, knowing he could not receive greater honour, expired in the King's arms in the seventy-fifth year of his age."

Leonardo's having made his will at Amboise, is no proof of his having died at Cloux, particularly as it was written some months before his death. And as it is well known that Fontainbleau was the favourite re- sidence of Francis, there is every reason to suppose that he would have desired Leonardo's assistance in the embellishment of that place. As he was also attached to the court and to the King personally, he would in all probability have been wherever his master was. Another reason Ammoretti gives for discrediting this anecdote, is the circumstance of Francesco Melzi's having written from Amboise to inform Da Vinci's brothers of his death. But is it not possible, and even probable, that Melzi, as his executor, should have gone to the place where his effects were, and of which he had also to give an account? At any rate, this story


LEONARDO DA VINCI. IxXXvi

is too pleasing a fiction, if it be one, to be slightly discredited ; and few would wish to disbelieve what tradition has handed down to us, Avhat all the poets and painters who have since touched on the subject have confirmed, and what is besides as glorious to Leonardo, as it is creditable to Francis.

To a noble presence and beautiful countenance. Da Vinci united uncommon strength both of body and mind. His eloquence was so persuasive, that Vasari says, " Con le parole sue volgeva al si e al no ogn' indurata intentione ;" and his physical force was so great, that he could bend a horse-shoe as if it were lead. He was very magnificent in his attire, and rather too fond of adorning his person in early life ; but these foibles were more than counterbalanced by the hospitality and liberality of his disposition. The founder of an academy over which he presided for some years, he may be supposed to have left a great many literary works, which are most of them in ma- nuscript, and preserved in different public libraries throughout Europe, Among these are a treatise on Hydraulics, with designs, another on Anatomy, and another on the Anatomy of the Horse, which is noticed by Vasari, Borghini, and Lomazzo ; and a treatise on Perspective and on Light and Shade. But his best- known work is the Trattato della Pittura, of which there are several editions ; an old one with etchings by Stefano della Bella, and a more recent one printed at Paris by Du Fresne in 1651, with figures by Nico- las Poussin. This was translated into English and published in London by John Senex in 172L The en- suing translation, by Rigaud, was first published in London in 1802.

As an engineer, the canal of the Martesana, by


Ixxxviii THE LIFE OF DA VINCI.

which he conducted the waters of the Adda to the walls of Milan, a distance of nearly two hundred miles, would have been alone sufficient to establish his repu- tation. In this great work he obliged the impediments of nature to give way to the efforts of genius, and he succeeded to the admiration of all Italy.

As a painter, Leonardo da Vinci may be considered the first who reconciled minute finishing with gran- deur of design and harmony of expression. His was the very poetry of painting. His exquisite taste, by continually making him dissatisfied with his works, urged him on to a nearer approach to perfection than had ever been attained. For this reason his scholars were superior to those of any other master, as he exacted from them the same profound attention to nature, and laborious minuteness of style, which dis- tinguished himself.

It is to be remembered, to the immortal honour of Leonardo da Vinci, that he first dissipated the film of ignorance which impeded the progress of the arts ; and if Raffaelle and Michael Angelo afterwards sur- passed him in his own line, it is to him that justly belongs the merit of having first pointed out the road which they so successfully followed. It is easier to improve than to invent ; but to him who had the talents to imagine and the courage to overcome the prejudices of ages, ought to belong the gratitude of posterity, more than to those who, by following his precepts, increased their own reputation. To no one, in short, arc the arts more largely indebted than to Leonardo da Vinci, whose virtues endeared him to all who knew him, and whose exertions so mainly con- tributed to the refinement and civilization of future ages.


CATALOGUE


OF THE PRINCIPAL


WORKS PAINTED BY LEONARDO DA VINCI.


It is difficult to give a correct catalogue of the works of any artist who lived at so distant a period as Leonardo da Vinci, and also to point out the different places where they are to be found, with the names of their respective owners : the more so, as works of art, as well as states and kingdoms, have so frequently changed masters of late years, that it is almost impossible to trace them through so many revolutions.

The most considerable of Leonardo's undertakings were those painted on the walls of the refectory in the Convent of the Madonna della Grazia, at Milan ; but, unfortunately, little remains of them to establish his fame in the present day. His grand painting of " The Last Supper," and his portraits of the Duke Ludovico il Moro, the Duchess Beatrice, and their children, are nearly defaced ; and in addition to the ravages of time, the figure of our Saviour, which he painted on the wall, is destroyed by the enlargement of a doorway.

At the Canonica de Vaprio, he painted his own por- trait by the side of a window, in the house of his friends the Melzi ; and in Vaprio, his colossal painting of the Virgin Mary is still to be seen in the palace belonging to the same family. In Rome he painted a figure of the Virgin on the wall of the cloisters in the Convent of St. e3


Xe CATALOGUE OF THE

Onofrio. But of all these little remains but the outlines, from the circumstance of their having been painted on walls, and as difficult to remove as to preserve.

His oil paintings are much more numerous, as he painted on wood, on canvass, and on paper. As Milan was the place where he resided longest, it may be sup- posed that he painted most of his pictures there ; but the greater part of those which could be removed, have long since been transported into other countries.

In the Public Gallery of Milan, are the portraits of the Duchess Beatrice and the Duke Maximilian. An- other copy of the latter is in the Melzi Gallery. There is also the portrait of an Old Man, and a half figure of St. John the Baptist, which is considered as Leonardo's work, in the Public Gallery ; but by some authors they are supposed to be only painted on his outlines.

In the Archbishop's Palace, a Virgin and Child, un- finished.

In the Palazzo Belgioso, a Holy Family that was at Piacenza ; and innumerable smaller pictures dispersed among the private collections in Milan, most of which have now found their way to England.

At Isola Bella, in the possession of the Boromeo family, there is a half figure of a Young Man, in very good pre- servation.

At Bologna. In the Hall of the Gonfaloniere, the portrait of a Boy. At Florence.

In the Public Gallery. — The Medusa's Head. A small picture in the Tribune representing Herodias re- ceivin the head of St. John tlie Baptist : by some this


WORKS OF DA VINCI. XCl

picture is attributed to Luino. The outlines, or rather the unfinished sketch of a large painting, representing the Epiphany, in the Scuola Fiorentina. And his own portrait, in the Hall of the Painters.

In the Palazzo Pitti^ a Magdalen ; most beautiful.

In the Palazzo Nicolini, the portrait of a Man.

In the IMozzi Gallery, the portrait of a Lady.

In the possession of Signor Fineschi is the famous picture of the Angel, described by Vasari, from the col- lection in the Palazzo Vecchio. This picture was for sale in 1828.

Ro7)ie.

In the Palazzo Borghese, a Holy Family. This is considered one of Leonardo's best pictures, and formerly belonged to Pope Clement the Seventh.

Palazzo Aldobrandinl. — Jesus Christ disputing with the Doctors of Law ; and the celebrated painting of La Vanitk et la Modestia. The former picture is now in the National Gallery in Loudon, and the latter was in 1828 in the possession of the late Earl of Dudley.

In the Giustiniani Gallery, a Holy Family ; now in England, in the collection of the Earl of Suffolk.

A very fine portrait of a Lady was in the possession of the late Count D'Albany ; and there was also a St. John in the collection of the Signora Angelica Kauffraann ; but these pictures are both removed ; the latter probably to Spain.

In Germany.

In the Imperial Gallery at Vienna — a picture of the Birth of our Saviour ; and an Herodias.

In the collection of Prince Kaunitz, the celebrated Leda.


XCU CATALOGUE OF THE

In the Gallery of Prince Lichtenstein, the Head of our Saviour. This is the picture so much praised by Winkelman as a model of manly beauty.

At Dresden, in the Public Gallery, the portrait of Gian Jacopo Triulzio, General of the French army under Francis I.

At Munich, in the Public Galler)', a painting of the Virgin.

In the Royal Collection at Berlin, a veiT fine picture of Vertumnus and Pomona.

Eussia.

At St. Petersburgh, in the Emperor's collection at the Hermitage, a Holy Family.

There ai'e several smaller pictures of less uote^ which are considered as the work of his scholars, some of them perhaps finished upon his outlines.

Spain.

At Madrid, in the Royal Gallery — Jesus Christ brought before Pilate. Tho pictures of the Virgin. A Head of St. John. This is most probably the picture that was in the collection of the Sigiiora Angelica Kauffmann, as most of her pictures were sent to Spain. A San Giro- lamo in the grotto.

France.

At Paris, in the Louvre — the portrait of Mona Lisa, wife of Francesco del Giocondo, a Florentine, usually called " La belle Joconde." This is generally considered as Leonardo's best work. It w as purchased by Francis I. far four thousand gold crowns, a sum which would now be equal to forty-five thousand francs. In the back-


WORKS OF DA VINCI. XCIU

ground is a landscape. Sir Abraham Hume^ Bart., has a copy of this picture.

The portrait of a Lady, supposed to be Lucretia Cre- velli. She is dressed in red.

A St. John holding the cross in one hand, and point- ing to heaven with the other.

A Holy Family, representing the infant Jesus giving his benediction to St. John, who is presented to him by Elizabeth. This picture is engraved by Desnayers.

A Holy Family, representing the Archangel Michael presenting Jesus the scales to weigh the good and evil actions of man : he is seated on the Virgin's lap, and they are both looking at Elizabeth and John the Baptist playing with a lamb.

Two pictures called Leonardo's, which are attributed rather to his school than to himself. One is St. John presenting the Cross of rushes to our Saviour. The other is St. Catharine of Alexandria at prayers.

A picture of the Virgin Mary sitting on the lap of Santa Anna, our Saviour and St. John playing at their feet. This is undoubtedly an original of Leonardo's : but has suffered very much from being over-cleaned, and is now greatly discoloured.

The Chevalier Gault relates that Monsieur de Chamois possesses one of Da Vinci's pictures representing Joseph and Potiphar's wife. He also says there is a group of Contadini in the Royal Gallery, but it exists there no longer.

The portrait of King Charles the Eighth of France, who died in 1497, for some time attributed to Leonardo, is now considered as the work of Perugino.

There are also several pictures in private collections in Paris, esteemed the works of Leonardo da Vinci ; but


XCIV CATALOGUE OF THE

the author has endeavoured to name only those Avhich are well known, and can be easily traced.

A picture has lately been discovered at Fontainebleau, which had long been given up as lost ; the subject is Leda, and it is spoken of in the highest terms of praise.

In England. The picture of Christ disputing with the Doctors of Law, formerly in the Aldobrandini Palace at Rome, is now in the National Gallery, having been bequeathed by the Rev. Holwell Carr, who purchased it from Lord Northwick, for 3,000 guineas.

La Colombina — purchased for 250 guineas by Robert Uduey, Esq. from the Orleans collection.

The Virgin, Child, and Angels, from the Escurial pa- lace, in the collection of Lord Ashburton.

Portrait of IMona Lisa, the wife of Francesco del Gio- condo, in the collection of Sir Abraham Hume, Bart. This picture is a repetition of the one at Paris, and, although a very fine painting, is not equal to it.

At Stowe, in the collection of his Grace the Duke of Buckingham, a Holy Family.

A Holy Family, in excellent preservation, and one of Leonardo's best compositions. This picture was pur- chased from Mr. Justice Crawley, of Luton in Bedford- shire, and came originally from Italy. It was lately in the possession of Mess. Woodburn, of St. Martin's-lane, who have caused it to be engraved, and have sold the picture to an Enghsh Nobleman. A smaller picture on this sub- ject, said to be painted by Da Vinci, is in the FitzwilUam Collection at Cambridge.

In the collection of the late Duke of Bridgevvater, was the portrait of a Woman, purchased by his Grace from


WORKS OF DA VINCI. XCV

the Orleans Collection, for 60 guineas, which is now in the possession of Lord Francis Egerton, at Cleveland House.

Herodias, in the Orleans collection, passed into the possession of Edward Coxe, esq. of Hampstead, and was sold again at his sale.

A Laughing Boy, with a play-thing in his hand. No- thing can exceed the masterly execution of this picture. It has the correctness of Raphael's drawing, and the graces and softness of Correggio's pencil. This picture was in the Arundel Collection, inherited by Lady Betty Germaine, who bequeathed it to Sir William Hamilton ; at whose sale, in April, 1801, it was purchased by Mr. Beckford for 13G.5/. It was at Fonthill, and is now at the Duke of Hamilton's. There are two drawings after the same Boy in the drawing book of Leonardo da Vinci, in the Ambrosian Library at Milan.

The Holy Family, that was in the Giustiniani Palace at Rome, is now in England in the collection of the Earl of Suffolk, at his seat at Charlton, near Malmesburv.

The pictuie of the Conception, originally in the church of San Francesco at Milan, is likewise in this country.

A fine picture of Francis I. in the character of our Saviour, was in 1828, in the possession of H. C. An- di'ews, Esq. of Sloane-street.


Several of the scholars of Leonardo da Vinci painted so like himself, that many of the pictures attributed to him belong more properly to his school, as his own occupa- tions were so various that he could not possibly have painted all the pictures that are reputed to be his own works.


XCVl VALUABLE DRAWINGS.


DKAWINGS.


A volume of valuable Drawings by Leonardo da Yinci, once the property of Pompeo Leoni, is now in the pos- session of his Britannic Majesty, and is at present kept at Cumberland Lodge. In it are contained 234 leaves, on which are pasted 779 drawings. It consists "' of a variety of elegant heads, some of which are drawn with red and black chalks, on blue or red paper ; others with a metal pencil on a tinted paper ; a few^ of them are washed and heightened with white, and many are on common paper. The subjects are miscellaneous, as portraits, caricatures, single figures, tilting, horses, und other animals ; botany, optics, perspective, gunnery, hydraulics, mechanics, and a great number of anatomical subjects, which are drawn with a more spirited pen, and illustrated with a variety of manuscript notes in his usual left-hand writing, in very fair characters. This volume contains the ver)- characteristic portrait of Da Vinci, by himself, which was engraved by Bartolozzi ; * together with sixteen other subjects, as male and female heads, characters, and caricatures ; and published by Mr, Chamberlaine under royal patronage.

His Majesty's drawing of the Lord's Supper is accu- rately executed on paper with black lead, and highly finished ; and formerly did honor to the Bonfiglioli col- lection at Bologna, f

  • Chamberlaine 's Life of Da Yinci, p. 11.

t Rogers' "Collection of Prints in imitation of Drawings, 1778," in which work is a copy in imitation of this drawing of the Last Supper, " W. W. Ryland sc. 1768."


BY LEONARDO DA VIXCI. XCVli

In 1778, Robert Uduey^ esq. possessed a coUectiou of 11 admirable Cartoons, containing 13 Heads in the Last Supper, which had been bought by the Procurator Sagre- do at Venice, with the rest of the Marquis of Casinidi's collection.* These were bought at Mr. Udney's sale by the late Mr. \Voodburu, who sold them to the Duke of Hamilton ; the latter bequeathed them to the Duke of Somerset, in whose possession the greater part, if not the whole, are at present.

In the collection bequeathed to the British Museum by Richard Payne Knight, esq., are three small drawings by Leonardo da Vinci ; 1 . a front portrait of Artus, chanj- berlain of Francis the First, remarkably fine ; 2. anotherj a profile head, fine ; and 3. in pen and ink, a fanciful bat- tle of monsters, a dragon, a bear, an unicorn, &c. A seated figure holds a shield, on which is reflected the sun, which is seen raging in the sky.

A valuable series of Leonardo's Drawings for the " Last Supper," which was in the Ambrosian Library at Milan, has since been purchased by Sir Thomas Ba- ring, Bart. They ^^•ere afterwards bought of Sir T. Ba- ring by the late Sir Thomas Lawrence. As that grand painting is so much destroyed, these drawings are of the highest interest. They have since, with about forty other drawings by Leonardo da Vinci, and the whole of Sir T. Lawrence's collection, come into the possession of Mess. ^Voodburn, St. Martin's-lanc. One of Leonardo's draw- ings for the Last Supper, is still in the Ambrosian Libra- ry at Milan. The late Sir T. Lawrence was desirous of adding it to his collection.

  • Rogers's " Prints in Imitation of Drawings," vol. i. p. 9.


XCVUl WORKS OF DA VIXCI.

MANUSCRIPTS.

Fourteen MS. volumes by Leonardo da Vinci are in the National Library at Paris, whither they were re- moved from the Anibrosian Library at Milan. J. B* Venturi (p. 4.) says, that they contain speculations in those branches of natural philosophy nearest allied to geometry ; that they are first sketches and occa- sional notes, the author always intending afterwards to compose from them complete treatises. They are written backwards from right to left, in the man- ner of the oriental writers, probably with intention that the curious should not rob him of his discoveries. The spirit of geometry guided him throughout, whether it were in the art of analysing a su|DJect in the connexion of the discourse, or the care of always generahzing his ideas. As to natural philosophy, he never was satisfied on any proposition if he had not proved it by experiment. Venturi has given extracts from Da Vinci's MSS. arranged under the following heads : Sect. \. Of the descent of heavy bodies, combined with the rotation of the earth. 2. Of the earth divided into particles. 3. Of the earth and the moon. 4. Of the action of the sun on the sea. 5. Of the ancient state of the earth. 6. Of the flame and the air. 7. Of statics. 8. Of the descent of heavy bodies by inclined planes. 9. Of the water which one draws from a canal. 10. Of whirlpools. IL Of vision. 12. Of military architecture. 13. Of some instruments. 14. Two chemical processes. 15. Of method.

In the Arundel collection of MSS. in the British Mu- seum, No. 263 is a paper Volume in 8vo^ ff. 2S3, written backwards, and illustrated by diagrams and delineations. It Is his rough book of observations and demonstrations


SCHOLARS OF DA VINCI. XCIX

on subjects chiefly of mixed mathematics ; being uncon- nected notes written by him at different times, com- mencing 22 jMarch 1508, on the mechanical powers of forces, percussion, gravityj motion, optics, astronomy, ike. with various arithmetical and geometrical propositions in Italian. Several memoranda occur in this volume, (noticed in the printed Catalogue of the Arundel MSS. p, 79,) particularly the death of his father Pietro da Vinci.


LIST OF LEONARDO DA VINCI S SCHOLARS, COLLECTED FROM HIS OWN NOTES AND MANUSCRIPTS.

Francesco Melzi.

Andrea Salaj'no, known in England by the

name of Solario. Marco Oggioni. Giau Antonio BeltrafBo. Cesarc da Sesto. Pietro Ricci detto Gianpedrino. Lorenzo Lotto. Nicolo Appiano.

Bernardino Foxolo, Fanfoya, Jachomo, and Bernardino Luino, wlio was not his scholar, properly speaking, but who painted after his manner, studied him closely, and coloured a great many of his drawings and cartoons, witli ahnost as much grace and softness as he could have done himself.

Lomazzo was more his friend and contemporary than his scholar, although he derived great benefit from his instructions.


MEMOIR


JOHN FRANCIS RIGAUD, ESQ. R.A.


John Francis Rigaud, (whose excellent Translation of the Treatise on Painting, by Leo- nardo da Vinci, forms the principal part of this Volume,) was born at Turin, in the kingdom of Sardinia, on the 18th of May, 17"<2. His father was a respectable merchant, the descendant of a Protestant family, which had left France at the revocation of the Edict of Nantz, and had settled at Turin, where they flourished among the first merchants of that celebrated city.

It was intended that the subject of this narrative should have followed the mercantile vocation of his father; and, for that purpose, he had been brought into the counting-house ; but, manifest- ing an unconquerable love for the art of painting? his father liberally consented to indulge his incli- nation, and afforded him every possible faciUty for prosecuting his favourite study. He immedi-


MEMOIR, &C. Ci

ately placed him under the care of one of the first Artists of that day, the Chevaher Beaumont, prin- cipal Painter to the King of Sardinia. Under his instructions he made rapid progress ; and leaving Turin, -when properly grounded in the art, he set out on his travels to visit the principal cities of Italy, to examine the most celebrated pictures of the great Masters ; and, with that •view, he stopped principally at Rome, at Bo- logna, and at Parma, where he successfully copied the famous picture of St. Jerome, by Corregio ; and, in consequence of his merit, he was elected, in 1766, a Member of the Clementine Academy of Bologna. In 177- he left Italy, and visited Paris, where he had offers of considerable employment •' but his tliirst for knowledge and fame being predo- minant, he rejected the patronage that was offered to him, determined to see the productions of the British School, and partake of the advantages of the establishment of the Royal Academy at Lon- don ; of which he hoped to become, by his assi- duity and abilities, a deserving Member. The first Picture that he exhibited in England, was the Hercules, which secured him great praise. In November of the same year, he was elected an Associate: and in 17S5 he was chosen a Royal Academician.

From the moment he received his first academic honours in this country- he was determined to settle in it, and continued to follow the Historic line of


Cll MEMOIR OF

Painting, which was his great dehght; occasionally painting Portraits, which he undertook with reluct- ance, regretting every moment that was not em- ployed in the higher department of Art.

Always anxious for improvement, he left Eng- land in the year 1782, to make a tour through Flanders and Germany, visiting all the great Col- lections : and having thus gratified himself with the sight of them, he explored the grand beauties of Nature in Switzerland. From Switzerland he returned to England, and from that time con- tinued the exercise of his professional talents with vigour and diligence. He painted some ceil- ings, which then, fortunately for Art, was the fashion of the time ; particularly one for the late Marquis of Donegal, at Fisherwick; the Library at Packington, in encaustic, for the present Earl of Aylesford ; and the ceiling of the Court Room at the Trinity House, on Tower Hill.

Having studied so much in Italy, where Fresco Painting was still practised, he was completely ac- quainted with its process ; and, by the encourage- ment of the Earl of Aylesford, who honoured him with his friendship and patronage, he was induced to paint for his Lordship an Altar-piece, in Fresco, for the Parish Church at Packington, his Lord- ship's Seat in Warwickshire ; which is svipposed to be the first Painting in Fresco executed in this country. He painted another Altar-piece, after the same manner, for the Parish Church of St.


J. F. RIGAUD, RA. CUl

Martin Ouhrich, in the city of London. His celebrated Picture of the Exposing of Moses, was so much admired by a Swedish gentleman, then on his travels in England, that he ordered a du- plicate, which was taken to Stockholm; and such was the impression it made in that city, that he was not only immediately elected a Member of its Royal Academy, but was appointed Historical Painter to the King of Sweden. In England he was employed in those great undertakings, the Poets, Shakspeare, and Historic Galleries.

His love for Painting was not evinced by his pencil only, his pen was also engaged in its ser- vice ; for he made an excellent translation of the Treatise on Painting by Leonardo da Vinci, and wrote an Essay for the periodical publication in- titled "The Artist," on the materials for Painting.

He continued in the perfect enjoyment of his faculties, and in the full exercise of his Art, until the very last moment of his life ; and he died as tranquilly as he had lived honourably; he was found dead in his bed, at the Seat of the Earl of Aylesford, at Packington in Warwickshire, on the 6th of December 1810, in the sixty-ninth year of his age.

As an Artist, his Works will convey his name with high respect to posterity. Many of his best Easel Pictures were comprised in a Sale of his Col- lection by Mr. Peter Coxe, April 3, 1811, (wh« 


civ MEMOIR, &C.

prefixed to the Catalogue this memoir, of which we gladly avail ourselves.)

As a man, he was an agreable member of so- ciety, had a rich fund of general knowledge, and showed an urbanity of manners which rendered him universally pleasing: the recollection of which will endear his memory to all who had the happi- ness of knowing him. He was eminently upright, of quick sensibility, warm and sincere in friend- ship, a good husband, and an excellent father.

A portrait of Mr. Rigaud, drawn by George Dance, R.A. in 1/93, and engraved by William Daniel, R.A., will be found in the second volume of Dance's Collection of Portraits, fol. 1814.

Throgmorton Street, 1811.


Actual text

TREATISE ON PAINTING.


DRAWING.


PROPORTION.

Chap. I. — TVhat the young Student in Painting ought in the first place to learn.

The young student should, in the first place, acquire a knowledge of perspective, to enable him to give to every object its proper dimensions : after which, it is requisite that he be under the care of an able master, to accustom him, by degrees, to a good style of drawing the parts. Next, he must study Nature, in order to confirm and fix in his mind the reason of those precepts which he has learnt. He must also bestow some time in ^4ewing the works of various old masters, to form his eye and judgment, in order that he may be able to put in practice all that he has been taught.*

  • This passage has been by some persons much misunderstood,

and supposed to require, that the student should be a deep pro- B


2 PROPORTION.

Chap. II. — Rule for a young Student in Painting.

The organ of sight is one of the quickest, and takes in at a single glance an infinite variet}'^ of forms ; notwithstanding which, it cannot perfectly comprehend more than one object at a time. For examj^le, the reader, at one look over this page, immediately perceives it full of different characters; but he cannot at the same moment distinguish each letter, much less can he comprehend their meaning. He must consider it word by word, and line by line, if he be desirous of forming a just notion of these characters. In like manner, if we wish to ascend to the top of an edifice, we must be content to ad- vance step by step, otherwise we shall never be able to attain it.

A young man, who has a natural inclination to the study of this art, I would advise to act thus : In order to acquire a true notion of the form of things, he must begin by studying the parts which compose them, and not pass to a second till he has well stored his memory, and sufficiently practised the first ; otherwise he loses his time, and will most certainly protract his studies. And let him remem- ber to acquire accuracy before he attempts quick- ness.

licient in perspective, before be commences the study of painting; but it is a knowledge of the leading principles only of perspective that the author here means, and without such a knowledge, which is easily to be acquired, the student will inevitably fall into errors, as gross as those humourously pointed out by Hogarth, in his Frontispiece to Kirby's Perspective.


PROPORTION. 3

Chap. III. — Hoiv to discover a young Man^s Disposition for Painting.

Many are very desirous of learning to draw, and are very fond of it, who are, notwithstanding, void of a proper disposition for it. This may be known by their want of perseverance ; like boys, who draw every thing in a hurry, never finishing, or shadowing.

Chap. IV. — Of Painting, and its Divisions.

Painting is divided into two principal parts. The first is the figure, that is, the lines which dis- tinguish the forms of bodies, and their compo- nent parts. The second is the colour contained within those limits.

Chap. V. — Division of the Figure.

The form of bodies is divided into two parts ; that is, the proportion of the members to each other, which must correspond with the whole; and the motion, expressive of what passes in the mind of the living figure.

Chap. VI. — Proportion of Members. The proportion of members is again divided into two parts, viz. equality, and motion. By equality is meant (besides the measure corresponding with the whole), that you do not confound the members of a young subject with those of old age, nor plump B 2


4 PROPORTION.

ones with those that are lean ; and that, moreover, you do not blend the robust and firm muscles of man with feminine softness: that the attitudes and motions of old age be not expressed with the quick- ness and alacrity of youth; nor those of a female figure hke those of a vigorous young man. The motions and members of a strong man should be such as to express his perfect state of health.

Chap. VII. — Of Dimensions in general.

In general, the dimensions of the human body are to be considered in the length, and not in the breadth ; because in the wonderful works of Na- ture, which we endeauvour to imitate, we cannot in any species find any one part in one model precisely similar to the same part in another. Let us be at- tentive, therefore, to the variation of forms, and avoid all monstrosities of proportion ; such as long legs united to short bodies, and narrow chests with long arms. Observe also attentively the measure of joints, in which Nature is apt to vary consider- ably ; and imitate her example by doing the same.

Chap. VIII. — Motion, Changes, and Proportion of Members.

The measures of the human body vary in each member, according as it is more or less bent, or seen in difi'erent views, increasing on one side as much as they diminish on the other.


PROPORTION. 5

Chap. IX. — The Difference of Proportion be- tween Children and grown Men.

In men and children I find a great difference between the joints of the one and the other, in the length of the bones. A man has the length of two heads from the extremity of one shoulder to the other, the same from the shoulder to the elbow, and from the elbow to the fingers ; but the child has only one, because Nature gives the pro- per size first to the seat of the intellect, and after- wards to the other parts.

Chap. X. — TJie Alterations in the Proportion of the human Body from Infancy to full Age.

A man, in his infancy, has the breadth of his shoulders equal to the length of the face, and to the length of the arm from the shoulder to the elboAV, when the arm is bent.* It is the same again from the lower belly to the knee, and from the knee to the foot. But, when a man is arrived at the period of his full growth, every one of these dimensions l3ecomes double in length, except the face, which, with the top of the head, undergoes but very little alteration in length. A well-pro- portioned and full-grown man, therefore, is ten times the length of his face ; the breadth of his shoulders will be two faces, and in like manner all the above lengths will be double. Tlie rest will

  • See Chap, cccli.


6 PROPORTION.

be explained in the general measurement of the human body.*

Chap. XI. — Of the Proportion of Members.

All the parts of any animal whatever must be correspondent with the whole. So that, if the body be short and thick, all the members belonging to it must be the same. One that is long and thin must have its parts of the same kind ; and so of the middle size. Something of the same may be observed in plants, when uninjured by men or tempests : for, when thus injured they bud and grow again, making young shoots from old plants, and by those means destroying their natural sym- metr}\

Chap. XII. — That every Part be proportioned to its Whole.

If a man be short and thick, be careful that all his members be of the same nature, viz. short arms and thick, large hands, short fingers, with broad joints; and so of the rest.

Chap. XIII. — Of the Proportion of the Members.

Measure upon yourself the proportion of the parts, and, if you find any of them defective, note it down, and be very careful to avoid it in drawing your own compositions. For this is reckoned a common fault in j^ainters, to delight in the imita- tion of themselves.

  • Not to be found in this work.


PROPORTIOX. 7

Chap. XIV. — The Danger of forming an erro- neous Judgment in regard to the Proportion and Beauty of the Parts.

If the painter has clumsy hands, he wiU be apt to introduce them into his works, and so of any other part of his person, which may not happen to be so beautiful as it ought to be. He must, there- fore, guard particularly against that seK-love, or too good opinion of his own person, and study by every means to acquire the knowledge of what is most beautiful, and of his own defects, that he may adopt the one and avoid the other.

Chap. XV. — Another Precept.

The young painter must, in the first instance, accustom his hand to coppng the drawings of good masters ; and when his hand is thus formed, and ready, he should, with the ad^^ce of his di- rector, use himself also to draw from relievos; according to the rules M'e shall point out in the treatise on drawing from relievos.*

  • From this, and many other similar passages, it is evident,

that the author intended at some future time to arrange his ma- nuscript collections, and to publish them as separate treatises. That he did not do so is well known ; but it is also a fact, that, in selecting from the whole mass of his collections the chapters of which the present work consists, great care appears in general to have been taken to extract also those to which there was any re- ference from any of the chapters intended for this work, or whicli from their subject were necessarily connected with them. Accord- ingly, the reader will find, in the notes to this translation, that


PROPORTION.

Chap. XVI. — The Manner of drawing from Relievos, and rendering Paper fit for it.

When you draw from relievos, tinge your paper of some darkish demi-tint. And after you have made your outline, put in the darkest shadows, and, last of aU, the principal lights, but sparingly, especially the smaller ones; because those are easily lost to the eye at a very moderate distance.*

Chap. XVII. — Of drawing from Casts or Nature.

In drawing from relievo, the draftsman must place himself in such a manner, as that the eye of the figure to be drawn be level with his own.f

all such chapters ia any other part of the present work are uni- formly pointed out, as have any relation to the respective passages in the text. This, which has never before been done, though in- dispensably necessary, will be found of singular use, and it was thought proper here, once for all, to notice it.

In the present instance the chapters, referring to the subject in the text, are Chap. xv. xvii. xviii. xix. xx. xxvi. ; and though these do not afford complete information, yet it is to be remem- bered, that drawing from relievos is subject to the very same rules as drawing from Nature ; and that, therefore, what is elsewhere said on that subject is also equally applicable to this.

  • The meaning of this is, that the last touches of light, such as

the shining parts (which are always narrow), must be given spar- ingly. In short, that the drawing must be kept in broad masses as much as possible.

f This is not an absolute rule, but it is a very good one for drawing of portraits.


PROPORTION. y

Chap. XVIII. — To draw Figures from Nature.

Accustom yourself to hold a plummet in your hand, that you may judge of the bearing of the parts.

Chap. XIX. — Of drawing from Nature.

When you draw from Nature, you must be at the distance of three times the height of the ob - ject ; and when you begin to draw, form in your own mind a certain principal line (suppose a per- pendicular) ; observe well the bearing of the parts towards that line ; whether they intersect it, are parallel to it or obhque.

Chap. XX. — Of drawing Academy Figures.

When you draw from a naked model, always sketch in the whole of the figure, suiting all the members well to each other ; and though you finish only that part which appears the best, have a re- gard to the rest, that, whenever you make use of such studies, all the parts may hang together.

In composing your attitudes, take care not to turn the head on the same side as the breast, nor let the arm go in a line with the leg.* If the head turn towards the right shoulder, the parts must be lower on the left side than on the other : but if the chest come forM'ard, and the head turn towards the left, the parts on the right side are to be the highest.

  • See Chap. ci.

B 5


10 PROPORTION.

Chap. XXI. — Of studying in the Dark, on first waking in the Morning, and before going to sleep.

I have experienced no small benefit^ when in the dark and in bed, by retracing in my mind the outlines of those forms which I had previously studied, particulai'ly such as had appeared the most difficult to comprehend and retain ; by this method they wall be confirmed and treasured up in the memory.

Chap. XXII. — Observations on drawing Portraits.

The cartilage, which raises the nose in the mid- dle of the face, varies in eight different ways. It is equally straight, equally concave, or equally con- vex, which is the first sort. Or, secondly, un- equally straight, concave, or convex. Or, thirdly, straiglit in the upper part, and concave in the under. Or, fourthly, straight again in the upper part, and convex in those below. Or, fifthly, it may be concave and straight beneath. Or, sixthly, concave above, and convex below. Or, seventhly, it may be convex in the upper part, and straight in the lower. And in the eighth and last place, convex above, and concave beneath.

The uniting of the nose with the brows is in two ways, either it is straight or concave. The forehead has three different forms. It is straight, concave, or round. The first is divided into two parts, viz. it is either convex in the upper part, or in the lower, sometimes both ; or else flat above and below.


PROPORTION. J 1

Chap. XXIII. — The Method of retaining in the Memory the Likeness of a Man, so as to draw his Profile, after having seen him only once.

You must observe and remember well the varia- tions of the four principal features in the profile ; the nose, mouth, chin, and forehead. And first of the nose, of which there are three different sorts,* straight, concave, and convex. Of the straight there are but four variations, short or long, high at the end, or low. Of the concave there are three sorts ; some have the concavity above, some in the middle, and some at the end. The convex noses also vary three ways ; some project in the upper part, some in the middle, and others at the bot- tom. Nature, which seems to delight in infinite variety, gives again three changes to those noses which have a projection in the middle; for some have it straight, some concave, and some convex.

Chap. XXIV. — How to remember the Form of a Face.

If you wish to retain with facility the general look of a face, you must first learn how to draw well several faces, mouths, eyes, noses, chins, throats, necks, and shoulders ; in short, all those principal parts which distinguish one man from another. For instance, noses are of ten different sorts -.f straight, bunched, concave, some raised above, some below

  • See the preceding chapter.

f See the two preceding chapters.


12 PROPORTION.

the middle^ aqueline, flat, round, and sharp. These afFeci the profile. In the front view there are eleven different sorts. Even, thick in the middle, thin in the middle, thick at the tip, thin at the beginning, thin at the tip, and thick at the beginning. Broad, narrow, high, and low nostrils ; some with a large opening, and some more shut towards the tip.

The same variety will be found in the other parts of the face, which must be drawn from Nature, and retained in the memory. Or else, when you mean to draw a likeness from memory, take with you a pocket-book, in which you have marked all these variations of features, and after having given a look at the face you mean to draw, retire a little aside, and note down in your book which of the features are similar to it j that you may put it all together at home.

Chap. XXV. — That a Painter should take Plea- sure in the Opinion of every body.

A painter ought not certainly to refuse listening to the opinion of any one ; for we know that, although a man be not a painter, he may have just notions of the forms of men j whether a man has a hump on his back, a thick leg, or a large hand 5 whether he be lame, or have any other defect. Now, if we know that men are able to judge of the works of Nature, should we not think them more able to detect our errors?


13


ANATOMY.

Chap. XXVI. — JVhat is principally to be observed in Figures.

The principal and most important considera- tion required in drawing figures, is to set the head well upon the shoulders, the chest upon the hips, the hips and shoulders upon the feet.

Chap. XXYll.—Mode of Studying.

Study the science first, and then follow the practice which results from that science. Pursue method in your study, and do not quit one part tiD it be perfectly engraven in the memory ; and observe what difference there is between the members of animals and their joints.*

Chap. XXVIII. — 0/ being universal.

It is an easy matter for a man who is well versed in the principles of his art, to become universal in the practice of it, since all animals have a similarity of members, that is, muscles, tendons, bones, &c. These only varj' in lengtli or thickness, as wiU be demonstrated in the Anatomy.f As for aquatic animals, of which there is great variety, I shall not

  • Man being the highest of the animal creation, ought to be

the chief object of study.

■f" An intended Treatise, as it seems, on Anatomy, which how- ever never was published ; but there are several chapters in the present work on the subject of Anatomy, most of which will be


Wf


14 ANATOMY.


persuade the painter to take them as a rule, hav- ing no connexion with our purpose.

Chap. XXIX. — A Precept for the Painter.

It reflects no great honour on a painter to be able to execute only one thing well, such as a head, an academy figure, or draperies, animals, landscape or the like, confining himself to some particular object of study; because there is scarcely a person so void of genius as to fail of success, if he apply earnestly to one branch of study, and practise it continually.

Chap. XXX. — Of the Measures of the human Body, and the bending of Members.

It is very necessary that painters should have a knowledge of the bones which support the flesh by which they are covered, but particularly of the joints, which increase and diminish the length of them in their appearance. As in the arm, which does not measure the same when bent, as when extended ; its difference between the greatest ex- tension and bending, is about one eighth of its length. The increase and diminution of the arm is effected by the bone- projecting out of its socket at the elbow ; which, as is seen in figure A B,

found under the present head of Anatomy ; and of such as could not be placed there, because they also related to some other branch, the following is a list by which they may be found; Chap- ters VI. VII. X. XI. XXXIV. XXXV. XXXVI. XXXVIl. XXXVIII. XXXIX. XL. XLI. XLII. XLIII. XLIV. XLV. XLVI. XLVIII. XLIX. L. LI, LII. CXXIX.


ANATOMY. 15

Plate I. is lengthened from the shoulder to the elbow ; the angle it forms being less than a right angle. It will appear longer as that angle be- comes more acute, and vnll shorten in proportion as it becomes more open or obtuse.

Chap. XXXI. — Of the small Bones in several Joints of the human Body.

There are in the joints of the human body cer- tain small bones, fixed in the middle of the ten- dons which connect several of the joints. Such are the patellas of the knees and the joints of the shoulders, and those of the feet. They are eight in number, one at each shoulder, one at each knee, and two at each foot under the first joint of the great toe towards the heel. These grow extremely hard as a man advances in years.

Chap. XXXII. — Memorandum to be observed by the Painter.

Note down which muscles and tendons are brought into action by the motion of any member, and when they are hidden. Remember that these remarks are of the greatest importance to painters and sculptors, who profess to study anatomy, and the science of the muscles. Do the same with children, following the different gradations of age from their birth even to decrepitude, descril^ing the changes which the members, and particularly the joints, undergo; which of them grow fat, and which lean.


16 ANATOMY.

Chap. XXXIIL— 7%e Shoulders. The joints of the shoulders, and other parts which bend, shall be noticed in their places in the Treatise on Anatomy, where the cause of the mo- tions of all the parts which compose the human body shall be explained.*

Chap. XXXIV.— 77^e Difference of Joints between Children and grown Men.

Young children have all their joints small, but they are thick and plump in the spaces between them ; because there is nothing upon the bones at the joints, but some tendons to bind the bones together. The soft flesh, which is full of fluids, is enclosed under the skin in the space between the joints ; and as the bones are bigger at the joints than in the space between them, the skin throws off" in the progress to manhood that superfluity, and draws nearer to the bones, thinning the whole part together. But upon the joints it does not lessen^ as there is nothing but cartilages and ten- dons. For these reasons children are small in the joints, and plump in the space between, as may be observed in their fingers, arms, and narrow shoulders. Men, on the contrary, are large and full in the joints, in the arms and legs ; and where children have hollows, men are knotty and promi- nent.

  • See chap, lxxxvii.


ANATOMY. 17

Chap. XXXV. — Of the Joints of the Fingers.

The joints of the fingers appear larger on all sides when they bend ; the more they bend the larger they appear. The contrary is the case when straight. It is the same in the toes, and it wiU be more perceptible in proportion to their fleshiness.

Chap. XXXVI.— Of the Joint of the Wrist.

The wrist or joint between the hand and arm les- sens on closing the hand, and grows larger when it opens. The contrary happens in the arm, in the space between the elbow and the hand, on all sides; because in opening the hand the muscles are ex- tended and thinned in the arm, from the elbow to the \\'rist ; but when the hand is shut, the same muscles swell and shorten. The tendons alone start, being stretched by the clenching of the hand.

Chap. XXXYU.— Of the Joint of the Foot.

The increase and diniinution in the joint of the foot is produced on that side where the tendons are seen, as D E F, Plate I. which increases when the angle is acute, and diminishes when it becomes obtuse. It must be understood of the joint in the front part of the foot ABC.

Chap. XXXVIII.— 0//^e Knee. Of all the members which have pliable joints,


18 ANATOMY.

the knee is the only one that lessens in the bend- ing, and becomes larger by extension.

Chap. XXXIX.— 0/ Me Joints.

All the joints of the human body become larger by bending, except that of the leg.

Chap. XL.— Of the Naked.

When a figure is to appear nimble and delicate, its muscles must never be too much marked, nor are any of them to be much sAvelled. Because such figures are expressive of activity and swift- ness, and are never loaded with much flesh upon the bones. They are made light by the want of flesh, and where there is but little flesh there can- not be any thickness of muscles.

Chap. XLI. — Of the TJiickness of the Muscles.

Muscular men have large bones, and are in ge- neral thick and short, with very little fat ; because the fleshy muscles in their growth contract closer together, and the fat, which in other instances lodges between them, has no room. The muscles in such thin subjects, not being able to extend, grow in thickness, particularly towards their mid- dle, in the parts most removed from the extremi- ties.

Chap. XLII. — Fat Subjects have small Muscles.

Though fat people have this in common with


ANATOMY. 19

muscular men, that they are frequently short and thick, they have thin muscles ; but their skin con- tains a great deal of spongy and soft flesh full of air ; for that reason they are lighter upon the water, and swim better than musctdar people.

Chap. XLIII. — JVhich of the Muscles disappear in the Motions of the Body.

In raising or lowering the arm, the pectoral muscles disappear, or acquire a greater rehevo. A similar eff"ect is produced by the hips, when they bend either inwards or outwards. It is to be ob- served, that there is more variety of appearances in the shoidders, hips, and neck, than in any other joint, because they are susceptible of the greatest variety of motions. But of this subject I shall make a separate treatise*.

Chap. XLIV.— 0/ the Muscles. The muscles are not to be scrupulously marked all the way, because it would be disagreeable to the sight, and of A'ery difficult execution. But on that side only where the members are in action, they should be pronounced more strongly; for muscles that are at work naturally collect all their parts together, to gain increase of strength, so that

  • It does not appear that this intention was ever carried into

execution ; but there are many chapters in this work on the sub- ject of motion, where all that is necessary for a painter in this branch will be found.


20 ANATOMY.

some small parts of those muscles will appear, that were not seen before.

Chap. XIN.—Ofthe Muscles. The muscles of young men are not to be marked strongly, nor too much swelled, because that would indicate fuU strength and vigour of age, which they have not yet attained. Nevertheless they must be more or less expressed, as they are more or less employed. For those which are in motion are always more swelled and tliicker than those which remain at rest. The intrinsic and central line of the members which are bent, never retains its natural length.

Chap. XLVI. — Tlie Extension and Contraction of the Muscles. The muscle at the back part of the thigh shows more variety in its extension and contraction, than any other in the human body ; the second, in that respect, are those which compose the buttocks ; the third, those of the back; the fourth, those of the neck; the fifth, those of the shoulders ; and the sixth, those of the Abdomen, which, taking their rise under the breast, terminate under the lower belly; as I shall explain when I speak of each.

Chap. XLVIT. — Of the Muscle between the Chest and the loiver Belly. There is a muscle which begins under the breast


ANATOMY. 21

at the Sternum, and is inserted into, or terminates at the Os pubis, under the lower belly. It is called the Rectus of the Abdomen ; it is divided, length- ways, into three principal portions, by transverse tendinous intersections or ligaments, viz. the supe- rior part, and a hgament; the second part, with its hgaments ; and the third part, with the third ligament ; which last unites by tendons to the Os pubis. These divisions and intersections of the same muscle are intended by nature to facilitate the motion when the body is bent or distended. If it were made of one piece, it would produce too much variety when extended, or contracted, and also would be considerably weaker. When this muscle has but little variety in the motion of the body, it is more beautiful.*

Chap. XLVIII. — Of a Man's complex Strength, but first of the Arm.

The muscles which serve either to straighten or bend the arm, arise from the different processes of the Scapula; some of them from the protuberances of the Humerus, and others about the middle of

  • Anatomists have divided this muscle into four or five sec-

tions ; but painters, following the ancient sculptors, show only the three principal ones ; and, in fact, we find that a greater number of them (as may often be observed in nature) gives a dis- agreeable meagreness to the subject. Beautiful nature does not show more than three, though there may be more hid under the skin.


22 ANATOMY.

the Os humeri. Tlie extensors of the arm arise from behind, and the flexors from before.

That a man has more power in pulling than in pushing, has been proved by the ninth proposition De Ponderibus,* where it is said, that of two equal weights, that will have the greatest power which is farthest removed from the pole or centre of its balance. It follows then of course, that the muscle N B, Plate II. and the muscle N C, being of equal power, the inner muscle N C, will nevertheless be stronger than the outward one N B, because it is inserted into the arm at C, a point farther removed from the centre of the elbow A, than B, which is on the other side of such centre, so that that ques- tion is determined. But this is a simple power, and I thought it best to explain it before I men- tioned the complex power of the muscles, of which I must now take notice. The complex power, or strength, is, for instance, this, when the arm is going to act, a second power is added to it (such as the weight of the body and the strength of the legs, in pulling or pushing), consisting in the ex- tension of the parts, as when two men attempt to throw doAvn a column ; the one by pushing, and the other by pulling .f


  • A treatise on weights, like many otliers, intended by this

author, but never published, t See the next chapter.


ANATOMY. 23

Chap. XLIX. — In which of the tico Actions, Pull- ing or Pushing, a Man has the greatest Power, Plate II.

A man has the greatest power in pulUng, for in that action he has the united exertion of all the muscles of the arm, M'hile some of them must be inactive when he is pushing ; because when the arm is extended for that purpose, the muscles which move the elbow cannot act, any more than if he pushed with his shoulders against the column he means to throw down ; in which case only the muscles that extend the back, the legs under the thigh, and the calves of the legs, would be active. From which we conclude, that in pulling there is added to the power of extension the strength of the arms, of the legs, of the back, and even of the chest, if the oblique motion of the body require it. But in pushing, though all the parts were employed, yet the strength of the muscles of the arms is wanting ', for to push with an extended arm mth- out motion does not help more than if a piece of wood were placed from the shoulder to the column meant to be pushed down.

Chap. L. — Of the bending of Members, and of the Flesh round the bending Joint.

The flesh which covers the bones near and at the joints, swells or diminishes in thickness accord-


24 ANATOMY.

ing to their bending or extension ; that is, it in- creases at the inside of the angle formed by the bending, and grows narrow and lengthened on the outward side of the exterior angle. The middle between the convex and concave angle participates of this increase or diminution, but in a greater or less degree as the parts are nearer to, or farther from, the angles of the bending joints.

Chap. LI. — Of the naked Body.

The members of naked men who work hard in different attitudes, will show the muscles more strongly on that side where they act forcibly to bring the part into action ; and the other muscles will be more or less marked, in proportion as they co-operate in the same motion.

Chap. LII. — Of a Ligament without Muscles.

Where the arm joins with the hand, there is a ligament, the largest in the human body, which is without muscles, and is called the strong ligament of the Carpus ; it has a square shape, and serves to bind and keep close together the bones of the arm, and the tendons of the fingers, and prevent their dilating, or starting out.

Chap. LIII. — Of Creases. In bending the joints the flesh will always form a crease on the opposite side to that where it is tight.


ANATOMY, 25

Chap. LIV. — Hotv near behind the Back one Arm can be brought to the other, Plate III. and IV.

When the arms are carried behind the back, the elbows can never be brought nearer than the length from the elbow to the end of the longest finger ; so that the fingers will not be seen beyond the elbows^ and in that situation, the arms with the shoulders form a perfect square. The greatest extension of the arm across the chest is, when the elbow comes over the pit of the stomach ; the elbow and the shoulder in this position, will form an equilateral triangle.

Chap. LV. — Of the Muscles.

A naked figure being strongly marked, so as to give a distinct view of all the muscles, will not express any motion ; because it cannot move, if some of its muscles do not relax while the others are pulling. Those which relax cease to appear in proportion as the others pull strongly and be- come apparent.

Chap. LVI. — Of the Muscles.

The muscles of the human body are to be more or less marked according to their degree of action. Those only which act are to be shewn, and the more forcibly they act, the stronger they should be pronounced. Those that do not act at all must remain soft and flat.

c


2G ANATOMY.

Chap. LVII. — Of the Bending of the Body.

The bodies of men diminish as much on the side which bends, as they increase on the opposite side. That diminution may at last become double, in proportion to the extension on the other side. But of this I shall make a separate treatise*.

Chap. LVIII. — The same subject.

The body which bends, lengthens as much on one side as it shortens on the other; but the central line between them will never lessen or increase.

Chap. LIX. — The Necessity of anatomical Knoiv- ledge.

The painter who has obtained a perfect know- ledge of the nature of the tendons and muscles, and of those parts which contain the most of them, will know to a certainty, in giving a particular motion to any part of the body, which, and how many of the muscles give rise and contribute to it; which of them, by swelling, occasion their short- ening, and which of the cartilages they surround.

He will not imitate those who, in all the diffe- rent attitudes they adopt, or invent, make use of the same muscles, in the arms, back, or chest, or any other parts.

  • It is believed that this treatise, like many others promised

by the author, was never written.


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 27

MOTION AND EaUIPOISE OF FIGURES.


Chap. LX. — Of the Equipoise of a Figure standing still. The non-existence of motion in any animal rest- ing on its feet, is owing to the equality of weight distributed on each side of the line of gravity.

Chap. LXI. — Motion produced hy the Loss of Equilibrium.

Motion is created by the loss of due equipoise, that is, by inequaUty of weight; for nothing can move of itself, without losing its centre of gravity, and the farther that is removed, the quicker and stronger will be the motion.

Chap. LXII. — Of the Equipoise of Bodies, VlateY .

The l)alance or equipoise of parts in the human body is of two sorts, viz. simple and complex. Simple, when a man stands upon his feet without motion : in that situation, if he extends his arms at different distances from the middle, or stoop, the centre of his weight will always be in a per- pendicular line upon the centre of that foot which supports the body ; and if he rests equally upon both feet, then the middle of the chest will be per- c 2


28 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

pendicular to the middle of the line which mea- sures the space between the centres of his feet.

The complex balance is, when a man carries a weight not his own, which he bears by different motions ; as in the figure of Hercules stifling An- teus, by pressing him against his breast with his arms, after he has lifted him from the ground. He must have as much of his own weight thrown behind the central line of his feet, as the weight of Anteus adds before.

Chap. LXIII. — Of Positions.

The pit of the neck, between the two clavicles, falls perpendicularly with the foot which bears the weight of the body. If one of the arms be thrown forwards, this pit will quit that perpendicular; and if one of the legs goes back, that pit is brought forwards, and so changes its situation at every change of posture.

Chap. LXIV. — Of balancing the Weight round the Centre of Gravity in Bodies.

A figure standing upon its feet without motion, will form an equipoise of all its members round the centre of its support.

If this figure without motion, and resting upon its feet, happens to move one of its arms forwards, it must necessarily throw as much of its weight on the opposite side, as is equal to that of the ex-


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. '29

tended arm and the accidental weight. And the same I say of every part, which is brought out beyond its usual balance.

Chap. LXV. — Of Figures that have to lift up, or carry any Weight.

A weight can never be lifted up or carried by any man, if he do not throw more than an equal weight of his own on the opposite side.

Chap. LXVI. — TJie Equilibrium of a Man stand- ing upon his Feet, Plate VI.

The weight of a man resting upon one leg will always be equally divided on each side of the cen- tral or perpendicular line of gravity, which sup- ports him.

Chap. LXVIL— 0/ Walking, Plate VII.

A man walking will always have the centre of gravity over the centre of the leg which rests upon the ground.

Chap. LXVIII. — Of the Centre of Gravity in Men and Animals,

Tlie legs, or centre of support, in men and ani- mals, will approach nearer to the centre of gravity, in proportion to the slowness of their motion; and, on the contrary, when the motion is quicker, they will be farther removed from that perpendicular line.


30 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

Chap. LXIX. — Of the corresponding Thickness of Parts on each Side of the Body.

The thickness or breadth of the parts in the hu- man body will never be equal on each side, if the corresponding members do not move equally and alike.

Chap. LXX. — Of the Motions of Animals. All bipeds in their motions lower the part immediately over the foot that is raised, more than over that resting on the ground, and the highest parts do just the contrary. This is observable in the hips and shoulders of a man when he walks ; and also in birds in the head and rump.

Chap. LXXI. — Of Quadrupeds and their Motions. The highest parts of quadrupeds are susceptible of more variation when they walk, than when they are still, in a greater or less degree, in proportion to their size. This proceeds from the obhque posi- tion of their legs when they touch the ground, which raise the animal when they become straight and perpendicular upon the ground.

Chap. LXXII. — Of the Quickness or Slowness

of Motion.

The motion performed by a man, or any other

animal whatever, in walking, will have more or

less velocity as the centre of their weight is more or


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 31

less removed from the centre of that foot upon which they are supported.

Chap. LXXIII. — Of the Motion of Animals.

That figure wnll appear the swiftest in its course which leans the most forwards.

Any body, moving of itself, will do it with more or less velocity in proportion as the centre of its gravity is more or less removed from the centre of its support, lliis is mentioned chiefly in regard to the motion of birds, which, without any clap- ping of their wings, or assistance of wind, move themselves. This happens when the centre of their gravity is out of the centre of their support, viz. out of its usual residence, the middle between the two wings. Because, if the m.iddle of the wings be more backward than the centre of the whole weight, the bird will move forwards and downwards, in a greater or less degree as the centre of its weight is more or less removed from the middle of its wings. From which it follows, that if the centre of gravity be far removed from the other centre, the descent of the l^ird will be very oblique ; but if that centre be near the middle of the wings, the descent will have ver^^ Uttle obli- quity.

Chap. LXXIV. — Of a Figure moving against the Wind, Plate VIII. A man moving against the wind in any direc-


32 MOTION AkD EQUIPOISE. .

tion, does not keep his centre of gravity duly dis- posed upon the centre of support*.

Chap. LXXV. — Of the Balance of a Figure rest- ing upon its Feet.

The man who rests upon his feet, either bears the weight of his body upon them equally, or un- equally. If equally, it will be with some accidental weight, or simply with his own ; if it be with an additional weight, the opposite extremities of his members wiU not be equally distant from the per- pendicular of his feet. But if he simply carries his own weight, the opposite extremities wiU be equally distant from the perpendicular of his feet: and on this subject of gravity I shall write a se- parate bookf.

Chap. LXXVL— ^ Precept,

The navel is always in the central or middle line of the body, which passes through the pit of the stomach to that of the neck, and must have as much weight, either accidental or natural, on one side of the human figure as on the other. This is demonstrated by extending the arm, the wrist of which performs the office of a weight at the end of a steelyard ; and will require some weight to be thrown on the other side of the navel, to counter-

  • See chap. Ixiv.

+ See in this work from chap. Ix. to Ixxxi.


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 33

balance that of the wrist. It is on that account that the heel is often raised.

Chap. LXXVII. — Of a Man standing, but resting more upon one Foot than the otJier.

After a man, by standing long, has tired the leg upon which he rests, he sends part of his weight upon the other leg. But this kind of posture is to be employed only for old age, infancy, or extreme lassitude, because it expresses weariness, or very little power in the limbs. For that reason, a young man, strong and healthy, will always rest upon one of his legs, and if he removes a little of his weight upon the other, it is only a necessary pre- parative to motion, without which it is impossible to move ; as we have proved before, that motion proceeds from inequality*.

Chap. LXXVIII. — Of the Balance of Figures, Plate IX.

If the figure rests upon one foot, the shoulder on that side will always be lower than the other ; and the pit of the neck will fall perpendicularly over the middle of that leg wliich supports the body. The same will happen in whatever other view we see that figure, when it has not the arm much extended, nor any weight on its back, in its

• See chapters bd. Ixiv. c 5


34 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

hand, or on its shoulder, and when it does not, either behind or before, throw out that leg which does not support the body.

Chap. LXXIX. — In what Manner extending one Arm alters the Balance.

The extending of the arm, which was bent, re- moves the weight of the figure upon the foot which bears the weight of the whole body : as is observ- able in rope-dancers, who dance upon the rope with their arms open, \^dthout any pole.

Chap. LXXX. — Of a man hearintj a iveight on his Shoulders, Plate X. The shoulder which Ijears the weight is always higher than the other. This is seen in the figure opposite, in which the centre line passes through the whole, with an equal weight on each side, to the leg on which it rests. If the weight were not equally divided on each side of this central line of gravity, the whole would fall to the ground. But Nature has provided, that as much of the natural weight of the man should be thrown on one side, as of accidental weight on the other, to form a coun- terpoise. This is effected by the man's bending, and leaning on the side not loaded, so as to form an equilibrium to the accidental weight he carries; and this cannot be done, unless the loaded shoulder be raised, and the other lowered. This is the resource


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. S5

with which Nature has furnished a man on such occasions.

Chap. LXXXI. — Of Equilibrium.

Any figure bearing an additional weight out of the central line, must throw as much natural or ac- cidental weight on the opposite side as is sufficient to form a counterpoise round that line, which passes from the pit of the neck, through the whole mass of weight, to that part of the foot which rests upon the ground. We observe, that when a man lifts a weight with one arm, he naturally throws out the opposite arm ; and if that be not enough to form an equipoise, he will add as much of his OAvn weight, by bending his body, as will enable him to resist such accidental load. We see also, that a man ready to fall sideways and backwards at tlie same time, always throws out the arm on the opposite side.

Chap. l^XXXll.— Of Motion.

Whether a man moves with velocity or slow- ness, the parts above the leg which sustains the weight, will always be lower than the others on the opposite side.

Chap. LXXXIII.— 7%e Level of the Shoulders.

The shoulders or sides of a man, or any other animal, will preserve less of their level, in pro- portion to the slowness of their motion ; and vice


36 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

versdy those parts will lose less of their level when the motion is quicker. This is proved by the ninth proposition, treating of local motions, where it is said, any weight will press in the direction of the line of its motion ; therefore the whole mov- ing towards any one point, the parts belonging to it wiU follow the shortest line of the motion of its whole, without giving any of its weight to the collateral parts of the whole.

Chap. LXXXIV. — Objection to the above an- swered, Plates XI. and XII. It has been objected, in regard to the first part of the above proposition, that it does not follow that a man standing still, or moving slowly, has his members always in perfect balance upon the centre of gravity ; because we do not find that Nature always follows that rule, but, on the con- trary, the figure will sometimes bend sideAvays, standing upon one foot; sometimes it will rest part of its weight upon that leg which is bent at the knee, as is seen in the figures B. C. But I shall reply thus, that what is not performed by the shoulders in the figure C, is done by the hip, as is demonstrated in another place.

Chap. LXXXV. — Of the Position of Figures, Plate XIII. In the same proportion as that part of the naked figure marked D A^ lessens in height from


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 37

the shoulder to the hip, on account of its position the opposite side increases. And this is the reason : the figure resting upon one (suppose the left) foot, thatfootbecomes the centre of all the weight above; and the pit of the neck, formed by the junction of the two clavicles, quits also its natural situation at the upper extremity of the perpendicular line (which passes through the middle surface of the body), to bend over the same foot ; and as this line bends with it, it forces the transverse lines, which are always at right angles, to lower their extremities on that side where the foot rests, as appears in A B C. The navel and middle parts always preserve their natural height.

Chap. LXXXVI.— 0/ the Joints.

In the bending of the joints it is particularly useful to observe the difference and variety of shape they assume ; how the muscles swell on one side, while they flatten on the other ; and this is more apparent in the neck, because the motion of it is of three sorts, two of which are simple mo- tions, and the other complex, participating also of the other two.

The simple motions are, first, when the neck bends towards the shoulder, either to the right or left, and when it raises or lowers the head. The second is, when it twists to the right or left, with- out rising or bending, but straight, with the head turned towards one of the shoulders. The third


38 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

motion, which is called complex, is, when to the bending of it is added the twisting, as when the ear leans towards one of the shoulders, the head turning the same way, and the face turned up- wards.

Chap. LXXXVIL— 0/ the Shoulders. Of those which the shoidders can perform, simple motions are the principal, such as moving the arm upwards and downwards, backwards and forwards. Though one might almost call those motions in- finite, for if the arm can trace a circle upon a wall, it will have performed all the motions belonging to the shoulders. Every continued quantity being divisible ad infinitum, and this circle being a continued quantity, produced by the motion of the arm going through eveiy part of the circum- ference, it follows, that the motions of the shoul- ders may also be said to be infinite.

Chap. LXXXVIII.— O/'^Ae Motioyis of a Man.

^Vhen you mean to represent a man removing a weight, consider that the motions are various, viz. either a simple motion, by bending himself to raise the weight from the ground upwards, or when he drags the weiglit after him, or pushes it before him, or pulls it down with a rope passing through a pul- ley. It is to be obsers'ed, that the weight of the man's body pulls the more in proportion as the cen- tre of his gravity is removed from the centre of


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 39

his support. To this must be added the strength of the effort that the legs and back make w'hen they are bent, to return to their natural straight situa- tion.

A man never ascends or descends, nor walks at all in any direction, mthout raising the heel of the back foot.

Chap. LXXXIX.— 0/ the Disposition of Mem- bers preparinff to act with great Force, Plate XIV.

When a man prepares himself to strike a vio- lent blow, he bends and twists his body as far as he can to the side contrary to that which he means to strike, and collecting aU his strength, he by a complex motion, returns and falls upon the point he has in view.*

Chap. XC. — Of Throwing any Thing vAth Vio- lence, Plate XV.

A man throwing a dart, a stone, or any thing else with violence, may be represented, chiefly, two different ways ; that is, he may be preparing to do it, or the act may be already performed. If you mean to jilace him in the act of preparation, the inside of the foot upon which he rests will be under the perpendicular line of the pit of the neck; and if it be the right foot, the left shoulder will be perpendicular over the toes of the same foot.

  • See chapters civ. cliv.


40 MOTION AND EaUIPOISE.

Chap. XCI. — On the Motion of driving any thing into or drawing it out of the Ground. He who wishes to pitch a pole into the ground, or draw one out of it, will raise the leg and bend the knee opposite to the arm which acts, in order to balance himself upon the foot that rests, with- out which he could neither drive in, nor pull out any thing.

Chap. XCll.— Of forcible Motions, Plate XVI.

Of the two arms, that will be most powerful in its effort, which, having been farthest removed from its natural situation, is assisted more strongly by the other parts to bring it to the place where it means to go. As the man A, who moves the arm with a club E, and brings it to the opposite side B, assisted by the motion of the whole body.

Chap. XCIII.— 77te Action of Jumping.

Nature will of itself, and without any reasoning in the mind of a man going to jump, prompt him to raise his arms and shoulders by a sudden mo- tion, together with a great part of his body, and to lift them up high, till the power of the effort subsides. This impetuous motion is accompanied by an instantaneous extension of the body which had bent itself, like a spring or bow, along the back, the joints of the thighs, knees, and feet, and is let off obliquely, that is upwards and forwards ;


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 41

SO that the disposition of the body tending for- wards and upwards, makes it describe a great arch when it springs up, which increases the leap.

Chap. XCIV. — Of the three Motions in jumping upwards.

When a man jumps upwards, the motion of the head is three times quicker than that of the heel, before the extremity of the foot quits the ground, and tw4ce as quick as that of the hips ; because three angles are opened and extended at the same time : the superior one is that formed by the body at its joint Avith the thigh before, the second is at the joint of the thighs and legs behind, and the third is at the instep before.*

Chap. XCV. — Of the easy Motions of Members. In regard to the freedom and ease of motions, it

• The author here means to compare the difiFerent quickness of the motion of the head and the heel, when employed in the same action of jumping ; and he states the proportion of the former to be three times that of the latter. The reason he gives for this is in substance, that as the head has but one motion to make, while in fact the lower part of the figure has three successive operations to perform at the places he mentions, three times the velocity, or, in other words, three times the degree of eflFort, is necessary in the head, the prime mover, to give the power of in- fluencing the other parts ; and the rule deducible from this axiom is, that where two different parts of the body concur in the same action, and one of them has to perform one motion only, while the other is to have several, the proportion of velocity or effort in the former must be regulated by the number of operation* necessary in the latter.


42 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

is very necessary to observe, that when you mean to represent a figure which has to turn itself a lit- tle round, the feet and all the other members are not to move in the same direction as the head. But you will divide that motion among four joints, viz. the feet, the knees, the hips, and the neck. If it rests upon the right leg, the left knee should be a httle bent inward, with its foot somewhat raised outward. Tlie left shoulder should be lower than the other, and the nape of the neck turned on the same side as the outward ankle of the left foot, and the left shoulder perpendicular over the great toe of the right foot. And take it as a general maxim, that figures do not turn their heads straight with the chest, Nature ha\'ing for our convenience formed the neck so as to turn with ease on every side when the eyes want to look round ; and to this the other joints are in some measure subservient. If the figure be sit- ting, and the arms have some employment across the body, the breast will turn over the joint of the hip.

Chap. XCYl.— The greatest Twist ivhich a Man can 7nake, in turning to look at himself behind. Plate XVII.

The greatest twist that the body can perform is when the back of the heels and the front of the face are seen at the same time. It is not done without difficulty, and is effected by bending the


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 43

leg and lowering the shoulder on that side to- wards which the head turns. The cause of this motion, and also which of the muscles move first and which last, I shall explain in my treatise on anatomy.*

Chap. XCVII. — Of turning the Leg ivithout the TJiigh. It is impossible to turn the leg inwards or out- wards Avithout turning the thigh by the same mo- tion, because the setting in of the bones at the knee is such, that they have no motion but back- wards and forwards, and no more than is neces- sary for M'alking or kneeling ; never sideways, be- cause the form of the bones at the joint of the knee does not allow it. If this joint had been made pliable on all sides, as that of the shoulder, or that of the thigh bone with the hip, a man would have had his legs bent on each side as often as backwards and forwards, and seldom or never straight with the thigh. Besides, this joint can bend only one way, so that in walking it can never go beyond the straight line of the leg ; it bends only forwards, for if it could bend backwards, a man could never get up again upon his feet, if once he were kneeling; as when he means to get up from the kneeling posture (on both knees), he gives the whole weight of his body to one of the

  • It is explained in this work, or at least there is something

respecting it in the preceding chapter, and in chap. cli.


44 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

knees to support, unloading the other, which at that time feels no other weight than its own, and therefore is lifted up with ease, and rests his foot flat upon the ground ; then returning the whole weight upon that foot, and leaning his hand upon his knee, he at once extends the other arm, raises his head, and straightening the thigh with the body, he springs up, and rests upon the same foot, while he brings up the other.

Chap. XCVIII. — Postures of Figures.

Figures that are set in a fixed attitude, are ne- vertheless to have some contrast of parts. If one arm come before, the other remains still or goes behind. If the figure rest upon one leg, the shoulder on that side will be lower than the other. This is observed by artists of judgment, who always take care to balance the figure well upon its feet, for fear it should appear to fall. Because by resting upon one foot, the other leg being a little bent, does not support the body any more than if it were dead ; therefore it is necessary that the parts above that leg should transfer the cen- tre of their weight upon the leg which supports the body.

Chap. XCIX. — Of the Gracefulness of the Members.

The members are to be suited to the body in


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 45

graceful motions, expressive of the meaning which the figure is intended to convey. If it had to give the idea of genteel and agreeable carriage, the members must be slender and well turned, but not lean ; the muscles very slightly marked, indicating in a soft manner such as must neces- sarily appear ; the arms, particularly, pliant, and no member in a straight line with any other ad- joining member. If it happen, on account of the motion of the figure, that the right hip be higher than the left, make the joint of the shoulder fall perpendicularly on the highest part of that hip ; and let that right shoulder be lower than the left. The pit of the neck will always be perpendicular over the middle of the instep of the foot that supports the body. The leg that does not bear will have its knee a little lower than the other, and near the other leg.

In regard to the positions of the head and arms, they are infinite, and for that reason I shall not enter into any detailed rule concerning them ; suf- fice it to say, that they are to be easy and free, graceful, and varied in their bendings, so that they may not appear stifT like pieces of wood.

Chap. C. — That it is impossible for any Memory to retain the Aspects and Changes of the Mem- bers.

It is impossible that any memory can be able to


46 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

retain all the aspects or motions of any member of any animal whatever. This case we shaU exem- plify by the appearance of the hand. And be- cause any continued quantity is divisible ad infi- nitum, the motion of the eye which looks at the handj and moves from A to B, moves by a space A B, which is also a continued quantity, and con- sequently divisible ad infinitum^ and in every part of the motion varies to its view the aspect and figure of the hand ; and so it will do if it move round the whole circle. The same will the hand do which is raised in its motion, that is, it will pass over a space, which is a continued quantity.*


B


  • The eyeball moving up and down to look at the hand, de-

scribes a part of a circle, from every point of which it sees it in an infinite variety of aspects. The hand also is moveable ad in- finitum (for it can go round the whole circle — see chap. Ixxxvii), and consequently shew itself in an infinite variety of aspects, whica it is impossible for any memory to retain.


MOTION AND EQUIPOISE. 47

Chap. CI. — 77*6 Motions of Figures.

Never put the liead straight upon the shoulders, but a httle turned sideways to the right or left, even though the figures should l^e looking up or down, or straight, because it is necessary to give them some motion of hfe and spirit. Nor ever compose a figure in such a manner, either in a front or back view, as that every part falls straight upon another from the top to the bottom. But if you wish to introduce such a figure, use it for old age. Never repeat the same motions of arms, or of legs, not only not in the same figure, but in those which are standing by, or near; if the necessity of the case, or the expression of the subject you represent, do not obhge you to it*.

Chap. CII. — Of common Motions.

The variety of motions in man are equal to the variety of accidents or thoughts affecting the mind, and each of these thoughts, or accidents, Avill ope- rate more or less, according to the temper and age of the subject; for the same cause will in the actions of youth, or of old age, produce very dif- ferent effects.

Chap. CIII. — Of simple Motions.

Simple motion is that which a man performs in merely ])ending backwards or forwards.

  • See chap. xx. civ.


48 MOTION AND EQUIPOISE.

Chap. CIV. — Complex Motion.

Complex motion is that which, to produce some particular action, requires the body to bend down- wards and sideways at the same time. The painter must be careful in his compositions to apply these complex motions according to the nature of the subject, and not to weaken or destroy the effect of it by introducing figures with simple motions, without any connexion with the subject.

Chap. CV. — Motions appropriated to the Subject.

The motions of your figures are to be expressive of the quantity of strength requisite to the force of the action. Let not the same effort be used to take up a stick as would easily raise a piece of timber. Therefore shew great variety in the ex- pression of strength, according to the quality of the load to be managed.

Chap. CVI. — Appropriate Motions.

There are some emotions of the mind which are not expressed by any particular motion of the body, while in others, the expression cannot be shewn without it. In the first, the arms fall down, the hands and all the other parts, which in general are the most active, remain at rest. But such emotions of the soul as produce bodily action, must put the members into such motions as are


MOTION AXD EQUIPOISE. 49

appropriated to the intention of the mind. This, however, is an ample subject, and we have a great deal to say upon it. There is a third kind of mo- tion, which participates of the two already de- scribed ; and a fourth, which depends neither on the one nor the other. This last belongs to insen- sibihty, or fury, and should be ranked with mad- ness or stupidity ; and so adapted only to grotesque or Moresco work.

Chap. CVII. — Of the Postures of Women and young People.

It is not becoming in women and young people to have their legs too much asunder, because it denotes boldness; while the legs close together shew modesty.

Chap. CVIII. — Of the Postures of Children.

Children and old people are not to express quick motions, in what concerns their legs.

Chap. CIX. — Of the Motion of the Members.

Let every member l)e employed in performing its proper functions. For instance, in a dead body, or one asleep, no member should appear alive or awake. A foot bearing the weight of the whole body, should not be playing its toes up and down, but flat upon the ground; except when it rests entirely upon the heel.

D


50 LIXEAR PERSPECTIVE.

Chap. CX. — Of mental Motions. A mere thought, or operation of the mind, ex- cites only simple and easy motions of the body ; not this way, and that way, because its object is in the mind, which does not affect the senses when it is collected within itself.

Chap. CXI. — Effect of the Mind upon the Motions of the Body, occasioned by some outward Object.

When the motion is produced by the presence of some object, either the cause is immediate or not. If it be immediate, the figure will first turn towards it the organs most necessary, the eyes . leaving its feet in the same place ; and will only move the thighs, hips, and knees a little towards the same side, to which the eyes are directed.


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.


Chap. CXI I. — Of those who apply themselves to the Practice, without having learnt the Theory of the Art.

Those who become enamoured of the practice of the art, without having previously applied to the


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE. 51

diligent study of the scientific part of it, may be compared to mariners, who put to sea in a ship without rudder or compass, and therefore cannot be certain of arriving at the wished-for port.

Practice must always be founded on good theory; to this, Perspective is the guide and entrance, without which nothing can be well done.

Chap. CXIII. — Precepts in Painting.

Perspective is to Painting^what the bridle is to a horse, and the rudder to a ship.

The size of a figure should denote the distance at which it is situated.

If a figure be seen of the natural size, remem- ber that it denotes its being near to the eye.

Chap. CXIV. — Of the Boundaries of Objects, called Outlines or Contours.

The outlines or contours of bodies are so little perceivable, that at any small distance between that and the object, the eye will not be able to recognize the features of a friend or relation, if it were not for their clothes and general appear- ance. So that by the knowledge of the whole it comes to know the parts.

Chap. CXV. — Of linear Pa'spective.

Linear Perspective consists in giving, by D 2


52 LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.

established rules, the true dimensions of objects, according to their respective distances ; so that the second object be less than the first, the third than the second, and by degrees at last they be- come iuAasible. I find by experience, that, if the second object be at the same distance from the first, as the first is from the eye, though they be of the same size, the second will appear half the size of the first ; and, if the third be at the same distance behind the second, it will diminish two thirds ; and so on,, by degrees, they will, at equal distances, diminish in proportion ; provided that the interval be not more than twenty cubits * ; at which distance it will lose two fourths of its size ', at forty it will diminish three fourths ; and at sixty it will lose five sixths, and so on progres- sively. But you must be distant from your pic- ture twice the size of it ; for, if you be only once the size, it will make a great dilTerence in the mea- sure from the first to the second.

Chap. CXVI. — VFJiat Parts of Objects disappear first by Distance.

Those parts which are of less magnitude will first vanish from the sight f. This happens, be-

  • About thirteen yards of our measure ; the Florentine braccia,

or cubit, by which the author measures, being 1 foot 10 inches 7-8ths English measure.

t See chap. cxxi. and cccv.


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE. 53

cause the shape of small objects, at an equal dis- tance, comes to the eye under a more acute angle than the large ones, and the perception is less, in proportion as they are less in magnitude. It fol- lows then, that if the large objects, by being re- moved to a great distance, and consequently coming to the eye by a small angle, are almost lost to the sight, the small objects will entirely disappear.

CXVIL— 0/ remote Objects.

The outlines of objects will be less seen, in proportion as they are more distant from the eye.

Chap. CXVIII.— 0/ the Point of Siyht.

The point of sight must be on a level with the eyes of a common-sized man, and placed upon the horizon, which is the line formed by a flat country terminating with the sky. An exception must be made as to mountains, which are above that line.

Chap. CXIX. — A Picture is to be viewed from one Point only.

This will be proved by one single example. If you mean to represent a round ball very high up, on a flat and perpendicular wall, it will be neces- sary to make it oblong, like the shape of an egg, and to place yourself (that is, the eye, or point of


54 LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.

view) so far back, as that its outline or circumfer- ence may appear round.

Chap. CXX. — Of the Dimensions of the first Figure in an historical Painting.

The first figure in your picture will be less than Nature, in proportion as it recedes from the front of the picture, or the bottom line; and by the same rule the others behind it will go on lessen- ing in an equal degree.*

Chap. CXXI. — Of Objects that are lost to the Sight in Proportion to their Distance.

The first things that disappear, by being re- moved to some distance, are the outlines or boundaries of objects. The second, as they re- move farther, are the shadows which divide con- tiguous bodies. The third are the thickness of legs and feet; and so in succession the small parts are lost to the sight, till nothing remains but a confused mass, without any distinct parts.


  • It is supposed that the figures are to appear of the natural

size, and not bigger. In that case, the measure of the first, to be of the exact dimension, should have its feet resting upon the bottom line ; but as you remove it from that, it should diminish.

No allusion is here intended to the distance at which a picture is to be placed from the eye.


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE. 55

Chap. CXXII. — Errors not so easily seen in small Objects as in large ones.

Supposing this small object to represent a man, or any other animal, although the parts, by being so much diminished or reduced, cannot be executed with the same exactness of proportion, nor finished with the same accuracy, as if on a larger scale, yet on that very account the faults will be less conspicuous. For example, if you look at a man at the distance of two hundred yards, and M'ith all due attention mean to form a judgment, whether he be handsome or ugly, de- formed or well made, you will find that, with all your endeavours, you can hardly venture to decide. The reason is, that the man diminishes so much by the distance, that it is impossible to distinguish the parts minutely. If you wish to know by demonstration the diminution of the above figure, hold your finger up before your eye at about nine inches distance, so that the top of your finger corresponds with the top of the head of the distant figure : you will perceive that your finger covers, not only its head, but part of its body ; which is an evident proof of the appa- rent diminution of that object. Hence it often happens, that we are doubtful, and can scarcely, at some distance, distinguish the form of even a friend.


56 LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.

Chap. CXXIII. — Historical Subjects one above another on the same Wall to be avoided.

This custom, which has been generally adopted by painters, on the front and sides of chapels, is much to be condemned. They begin with an historical picture, its landscape and buildings, in one compartment. After which, they raise ano- ther compartment, and execute another history with other buildings upon another level; and from thence they proceed to a third and fourth, varying the point of sight, as if the beholder was going up steps, while, in fact, he must look at them all from below, which is very ill-judged in those matters.

We know that the point of sight is the eye of the spectator; and if you ask, how is a series of subjects, such as the life of a saint, to be repre- sented, in different compartments on the same wall ? I answer, that you are to place the prin- cipal event in the largest compartment, and make the point of sight as high as the eye of the spec- tator. Begin that subject with large figures ; and as you go up, lessen the objects, as well the figures, as buildings, varying the plans according to the effect of perspective ; but never varying the point of sight : and so complete the series of subjects, till you come to a certain height, where terrestrial objects can be seen no more, except


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE. 57

the tops of trees, or clouds and birds ; or if you introduce figures, they must be aerial, such as angels, or saints in glory, or the like, if they suit the purpose of your history. If not, do iiot undertake this kind of painting, for your work will be faulty, and justly reprehensible.*

Chap. CXXIV. — Why Objects in Painting can never' detach, as natural Objects do.

Painters often despair of being able to imitate Nature, from observing, that their pictures have not the same relief, nor the same life, as natural objects have in a looking glass, though they both appear upon a plain surface. They say, they have colours which surpass in brightness the qviality of the lights, and in darkness the quality of the shades of the objects seen in the looking-glass ; but attriljute this circumstance to their own igno- rance, and not to the true cause, because they do not know it. It is impossible that objects in

• The author does not me;in here to say, that one histoi'ical picture cannot be hung over another. It certainly may, he- cause, in viewing each, the spectator is at liberty (especially if they are subjects independent of each other) to shift his place so as to stand at the true point of sight for viewing every one of them ; but in covering a wall with a succession of subjects from the same history, the author considers the whole as in fact hut one picture, divided into compartments, and to be seen at one view, and which cannot therefore admit more than one point of sight. In the former case the pictures are, in fact, so many dis- tinct subjects unconnected with each other.

D 5


58


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.


painting should appear vnth the same relief as those in the looking-glass, unless we look at them with only one eye.

The reason is this. The two eyes A B looking at objects one behind another, as M and N, see them both : because M cannot entirely occupy the space of N, by reason that the base of the visual rays is so broad, that the second object is seen behind the first. But if one eye be shut, and you look with the other S, the body F will entirely cover the body R, because the visual rays beginning at one point, form a triangle, of which the body F is the base, and being prolonged, they form two diverging tangents at the two extremi- ties of F, which cannot touch the body R behind it, therefore can never see it.*



  • See chap, cccxlviii.

This chapter is obscure, and may probably be made clear by merely stating it in other words. Leonardo objects to the use of both eyes, because, in viewing in that manner the objects here meationed, two balls, one behind the other, the second is seen,


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE. 59

Chap. CXXV. — How to give the proper Dimen- sion to Objects in Painting.

In order to give the appearance of the natural size, if the piece be small (as miniatures), the

which would not be the case, if the angle of the visual rays were not too big for the first object. Whoever is at all acquainted with optics, need not be told, that the visual rays commence in a single point in the centre, or nearly the centre of each eye, and continue diverging. But, in using both eyes, the visual rays proceed not from one and the same centre, but from a different centre in each eye, and intersecting each other, as they do a a little before passing the first object, they become together broader than the extent of the first object, and consequently give a view of part of the second. On the contrary, in using but one eye, the visual rays proceed but from one centre ; and as, there- fore, there cannot be any intersection, the visual rays, when they reach the first object, are not broader than the first object, and the second is completely hidden. Properly speaking, therefore, in using both eyes we introduce more than one point of sight, which renders the perspective false in the painting ; but in using one eye only, there can be, as there ought, but one point of sight. There is, however, this diflference between viewing real objects and those represented in painting, that in looking at the former, whether we use one or both eyes, the objects, by being actually detached from the back ground, admit the visual rays to strike on them, so as to form a correct perspective, from whatever point they are viewed, and the eye accordingly forms a perspec- tive of its own ; but in viewing the latter, there is no possibility of varying the perspective ; and, unless the picture is seen pre- cisely under the same angle as it was painted under, the perspec- tive in all other views must be false. This is observable in the perspective views painted for scenes at the playhouse. If the beholder is seated in the central line of the house, whether in the boxes or pit, the perspective is correct ; but, in proportion as he is placed at a greater or less distance to the right or left of that line, the perspective appears to him more or less faulty. And hence arises the necessity of using but one eye in viewing « painting, in order thereby to reduce it to one point of sight.


60


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.


figures on the fore-ground are to be finished with as much precision as those of any large painting, because being small they are to be brought up close to the eye. But large paintings are seen at some distance ; whence it happens, that though the figures in each are so different in size, in ap- pearance they will be the same. This proceeds from the eye receiving those objects under the same angle ; and it is proved thus. Let the large



painting be B C, the eye A, and D E a pane of glass, through which are seen the figures situated at B C. I say that the eye being fixed, the figures in the copy of the paintings B Care to be smaller, in proportion as the glass D E is nearer the eye A, and are to be as precise and finished. But if you will execute the picture B C upon the glass D E, this ought to be less finished than the picture B C, and more so than the figure M N transferred upon the glass F G ; because, supposing the figure P O to be as much finished as the natural one in B C, the perspective of O P would be false, since, thouffh in regard to the diminution of the figure


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE. 61

it would be right, B C being diminished in P O, finishing Avould not agree with the distance, be- cause in giving it the perfection of the natural B C, B C would appear as near as O P ; but, if you search for the diminution of O P, O P will be found at the distance B C, and the dimi- nution of the finishing as at F G.

Chap. CXXVI. — Hoio to draw accurately any particular Spot.

Take a glass as large as your paper, fasten it well between your eye and the object you mean to draw, and fixing your head in a frame (in such a manner as not to be able to move it) at the dis- tance of two feet from the glass ; shut one eye, and draw with a pencil accurately upon the glass all that you see through it. After that, trace upon paper what you have drawn on the glass, which tracing you may paint at pleasure, observ- ing the aerial perspective.

Chap. CXXVII. — Disproportion to be avoided, even in the accessory Parts.

A great fault is committed by many painters, which is highly to be blamed, that is, to represent the habitations of men, and other parts of their compositions, so Ioav, that tlie doors do not reach as high as the knees of their inhabitants, though, according to their situation, they are nearer to tlie


G2 LINEAR PERSPECTIVE.

eye of the spectator, than the men who seem wilhng to enter them. I have seen some pictures with porticos, supported by columns loaded with figures ; one grasping a column against which it leans, as if it were a walking stick, and other simi- lar errors, which are to be avoided with the greatest care.


63


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.


Chap. CXXVIII. — Precept for avoiding a bad Choice in the Style or Proportion of Figures.

The painter ought to form his style upon the most proportionate model in Nature; and after having measured that, he ought to measure him- seK also, and be perfectly acquainted with his own defects or deficiencies ; and having acquired this knowledge, his constant care should be to avoid conveying into his work those defects which he has found in his own person ; for these defects, becoming habitual to his observation, mislead his judgment, and he perceives them no longer. We ought, therefore, to struggle against such a preju- dice, which grows up with us ; for the mind, be- ing fond of its own habitation, is apt to represent it to our imagination as beautiful. From the same motive it may be, that there is not a woman, however plain in her person, who may not find her admirer, if she be not a monster. Against this bent of the mind you ought very cautiously to be on your guard.

Chap. CXXIX. — Variety in Figures.. A painter ought to aim at universal excellence ; for he will be greatly wanting in dignity, if he do


64 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION,

one thing well and another badly, as many do, who study only the naked figure, measured and pro- portioned by a pair of compasses in their hands, and do not seek for variety. A man may be well proportioned, and yet be tall or short, large or lean, or of a middle size ; and whoever does not make great use of these varieties, which are all existing in Nature in its most perfect state, will produce figures as if cast in one and the same mould, which is highly reprehensible.

Chap. CXXX. — Hoiv a Painter ought to proceed in his Studies.

The painter ought always to form in his mind a kind of system of reasoning or discussion within himself on any remarkable object before him. He should stop, take notes, and form some rule upon it; considering the place, the circumstances, the lights and shadows.

Chap. CXXXI. — Of sketching Histories and Figures.

Sketches of historical subjects must be slight, attending only to the situation of the figures, with- out regard to the finishing of particular members, which may be done afterwards at leisure, when the mind is so disposed.

Cii.vp. CXXXII. — Hoiv to study Composition.

The young student should begin by sketching slightly some single figure, and turn that on all sides, knowing already how to contract, and how to


IXVEXTION, OR COMPOSITION. 65

extend the members ; after which, he may put two together in various attitudes, we will suppose in the act of fighting boldly. This composition also he must try on all sides, and in a variety of ways, tending to the same expression. Tlien he may imagine one of them very courageous, while the other is a coward. Let these attitudes, and many other accidental affections of the mind, be with great care studied, examined, and dwelt upon.

Chap. CXXXIII.— 0//Ae Attitudes of Men.

The attitudes and all the members are to be disposed in such a manner, that by them the in- tentions of the mind may be easily discovered.

Chap. CXXXW.—VarietAj of Positions. The positions of the human figure are to be adapted to the age and rank ; and to be varied ac- cording to the difference of the sexes, men or women.

Chap. CXXXV. — Of Studies from Nature for History. It is necessary to consider well the situation for which the history is to be painted, particularly the height ; and let the painter place accordingly the model from which he means to make his studies for that historical picture ; and set himself as much below the object, as the picture is to be a])ove the eye of the spectator, otherwise the work will be faulty.


66 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

Chap. CXXXYl.—Of the Variety of Figures in History Painthig.

History painting must exhibit variety in its fullest extent. In temper, size, complexion, ac- tionsj plumpness, leanness, thick, thin, large, small, rough, smooth, old age and youth, strong and muscular, weak, with little appearance of mus- cles, cheerfulness, and melancholy. Some should be with curled hair, and some with straight; some short, some long, some quick in their motions, and some slow, with a variety of dresses and co- lours, according as the subject may require.

Chap. CXXXNll.— Of Variety in History.

A painter should delight in introducing great variety into his compositions, avoiding repetition, that by this fertility of invention he may attract and charm the eye of the beholder. If it be requi- site, according to the subject meant to be repre- sented, that there should be a mixture of men dif- fering in their faces, ages, and dress, grouped with Avomen, children, dogs, and horses, buildings, liills and flat country ; observe dignity and decorum in the principal figure; such as a king, magistrate, or philosopher, separating them from the low classes of the people. Mix not afflicted or weep- ing figures with joyful and laughing ones ; for Nature dictates that the cheerful be attended bv


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. GJ

Others of the same disposition of mind. Laughter is productive of laughter, and vice versa.

Chap. CXXXVIII.— 0/Me Age of Figures.

Do not bring together a number of boys with as many old men, nor young men with infants, nor women with men ; if the subject you mean to re- present does not oblige you to it.

Chap. CXXXIX.— 0/ Variety of Faces.

The Italian painters have been accused of a common fault, that is, of introducing into their compositions the faces, and even the whole figures, of Roman emperors, which they take from the antique. To avoid such an error, let no repeti- tion take place, either in parts, or the whole of a figure ; nor let there be even the same face in another composition ; and the more the figures are contrasted, viz. the deformed opposed to the beautiful, the old to the young, the strong to the feeble, the more the picture will please and be admired. These diflJerent characters, contrasted with each other, will increase the beauty of the whole.

It frequently happens that a painter, while he is composing, will use any little sketch or scrap of drawing he has by him, and endeavour to make it serve his purpose ; but this is extremely injudi- cious, because he may very often find that the


68 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

members he has drawn have not the motion suited to what he means to express ; and after he has adopted, accurately drawn, and even well finished them, he will be loth to rub out and change them for others.

Chap. CXL. — A Fault in Painters.

It is a very great fault in a painter to repeat the same motions in figures, and the same folds in draperies in the same composition, as also to make ah the faces alike.

Chap. CXLI. — How you may learn to compose Groups f 07' History Painting.

When you are well instructed in perspective, and know perfectly how to draw the anatomy and forms of different bodies or objects, it should be your delight to observe and consider in your walks the different actions of men, when they are talking, or quarrelling; when they laugh, and when they fight. Attend to their positions, and to those of the spectators ; whether they are attempting to separate those who fight, or merely lookers-on. Be quick in sketching these with slight strokes in your pocket-book, which should always be about you, and made of stained paper, as you ought not to rub out. When it is full, take another, for these are not things to be rubbed out, but kept with the greatest care; because forms and mo-


INVENTION, OR COMTOSITION. 69

tions of bodies are so infinitely various, that the memory is not able to retain them ; therefore preserve these sketches as your assistants and masters.

Chap. CXLII. — Hoto to study the Motions of the human Body.

The first requisite towards a perfect acquaint- ance with the various motions of the human body, is the knowledge of all the parts, particularly the joints, in all the attitudes in which it may be placed. Then make slight sketches in your pocket- book as opportunities occur, of the actions of men, as they happen to meet your eye, without being perceived by them ; because, if they were to ob- sei^ve you, they would be disturbed from that freedom of action, which is prompted by inward feeling; as when two men are quarrelling and angry, each of them seeming to be in the right, and with great vehemence move their eyebrows, arms, and all the other members, using motions appropriated to their words and feelings. This they could not do, if you Avanted them to imitate anger, or any other accidental emotion ; such as laughter, weeping, pain, admiration, fear, and the like. For that reason, take care never to be with- out a little book, for the purpose of sketching those various motions, and also groups of people standing by. This will teach you how to compose


70 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

history. Two things demand the principal atten- tion of a good painter. One is the exact outUne and shape of the figure ; the other, the true ex- pression of what passes in the mind of that figure, which he must feel, and that is very important.

Chap. CXLIII. — Of Dresses, and of Draperies and Folds.

Tlie draperies with which you dress figures ought to have their folds so accommodated as to surround the parts they are intended to cover; that in the mass of light there be not any dark fold, and in the mass of shadows none receiving too great a light. They must go gently over, describing the parts ; but not with lines across, cutting the members with hard notches, deeper than the part can possibly be ; at the same time, it must fit the body, and not appear hke an empty bundle of cloth ; a fault of many painters, who, enamoured of the quantity and variety of folds, have encumbered their figures, forgetting the in- tention of clothes, which is to dress and surround the parts gracefully wherever they touch ; and not to be filled vdth wind, like bladders pufi'ed up where the parts project. I do not deny that we ought not to neglect introducing some handsome folds among these draperies, but it must be done with great judgment, and suited to the parts, where, by the actions of the hmbs and position of


IXVENTIOX, OR COMPOSITION. /I

the whole body, they gather together. Above all, be careful to vary the quality and quantity of your folds in compositions of many figures ; so that, if some have large folds, produced by thick woollen cloth, others, being dressed in thinner stuff, may have them narrower ; some sharj) and straight, others soft and undulating.

Chap. CXLIV.— 0/ the Nature of Folds in Draperies.

Many painters prefer making the folds of their draperies with acute angles, deep and precise ; others with angles hardly perceptible j and some with none at all; but instead of them, certain curved lines.

Chap. CXLV. — How the Folds of Draperies ought to be represented, Plate XVIII.

That part of the drapery, which is the farthest from the place where it is gathered, will appear more approaching its natural state. Every thing naturally inclines to preserve its primitive form. Therefore a stuff or cloth, which is of equal thickness on both sides, will always incline to remain flat. For that reason, when it is con- strained by some fold to relinquish its flat situ- ation, it is observed that, at the part of its greatest restraint, it is continually making efforts to re- turn to its natural shape ; and the parts most distant from it re-assume more of their primitive


/J INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

state by ample and distended folds. For exam- ple, let A B C be the drapery mentioned above ; A B the place where it is folded or restrained. I have said that the part, which is farthest from the place of its restraint, v/ould return more toward its primitive shape. Therefore C being the far- thest, wdU be broader and more extended than any other part.

Chap. CXLVI. — How the Folds in Draperies ought to be made.

Draperies are not to be encumbered with many folds : on the contrary, there ought to be some only where they are held up with the hands or arms of the figures, and the rest left to fall with natural simplicity. They ought to be studied from nature ; that is to say, if a wooUen cloth be intended, the folds ought to be drawn after such cloth ; if it be of silk, or thin stuff, or else very thick for labourers, let it be distinguished by the nature of the folds. But never copy them, as some do, after models dressed in paper, or thin leather, for it greatly misleads.

Chap. CXLVII. — Fore-shortening of Folds, Plate XIX.

Where the figure is fore-shortened, there ought to appear a greater number of folds, than on the other parts, all surrounding it in a circular man-


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 73

ner. Let E be the situation of the eye. M N will have the middle of every circular fold suc- cessively removed farther from its outline, in proportion as it is more distant from the eye. In M O of the other figure the outlines of these circular folds will appear almost straight, because it is situated opposite the eye ; but in P and Q, quite the contrary, as in N and M.

Chap. CXLVIIL— 0/ Folds,

The folds of draperies, whatever be the motion of the figure, ought always to shew, by the form of their outlines, the attitude of such figure; so as to leave, in the mind of the beholder, no doubt or confusion in regard to the true position of the body ; and let there be no fold, which, by its shadow, breaks through any of the members ; that is to say, appearing to go in deeper than the surface of the part it covers. And if you repre- sent the figure clothed with several garments, one over the other, let it not appear as if the upper one covered only a mere skeleton ; but let it ex- press that it is also well furnished with flesli, and a thickness of folds, suitable to the number of its under garments.

The folds surrounding the members ought to diminish in thickness near the extremities of the part they surround.

The length of the folds, which are close to the


74 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

members, ought to produce other folds on that side where the member is diminished by fore- shortening, and be more extended on the opposite side.

Chap. CXLIX.— 0/ Decorum.

Observ^e decorum in every thing you represent, that is, fitness of action, dress, and situation, ac- cording to the dignity or meanness of the sub- ject to be represented. Be careful that a king, for instance, be grave and majestic in his coun- tenance and dress ; that the place be well deco- rated ; and that his attendants, or the by-standers, express reverence and admiration, and appear as noble, in dresses suitable to a royal court.

On the contrary, in the representation of a mean subject, let the figures appear low and des- picable; those about them with similar counte- nances and actions, denoting base and presump- tuous minds, and meanly clad. In short, in both cases, the parts must correspond with the general sentiment of the composition.

The motions of old age should not be similar to those of youth ; those of a woman to those of a man ; nor should the latter be the same as those of a boy.

Chap. CL. — Tlie Character of Figures in

Composition. In general, the painter ought to introduce very


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 7^

few old men, in the ordinary course of historical subjects, and those few separated from young people ; because old people are few, and their habits do not agree with those of youth. Where there is no conformity of custom, there can be no intimacy, and, without it, a company is soon separated. But if the subject require an appear- ance of gravity, a meeting on important business, as a council, for instance, let there be few young men introduced, for youth wiUingly avoids such meetings.

Chap. CLI. — The Motion of the Muscles, when the Figures are in natural Positioiis.

A figure, which does not express by its position the sentiments and passions, by which we sup- pose it animated, wdll appear to indicate that its muscles are not obedient to its will, and the painter very deficient in judgment. For that rea- son, a figure is to shew great eagerness and mean- ing ; and its position is to be so well appropriated to that meaning, that it cannot be mistaken, nor made use of for any other.

Chap. CLII. — A Precept in Painting. The painter ought to notice those quick mo- tions, which men are apt to make without think- ing, when impelled by strong and powerful affec- tions of the mind. He ought to take memoran- E 2


76 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

dums of them, and sketch them in his pocket- book, in order to make use of them when they may answer his purpose ; and then to put a hving model in the same position, to see the quahty and aspect of the muscles which are in action.

Chap. CLIIL— 0/ the Motion of Man, Plates XX. and XXI.

The first and principal part of the art is com- position of any sort, or putting things together. The second relates to the expression and motion of the figures, and . requires that they be well appropriated, and seeming attentive to what they are about ; appearing to move with alacrity and spirit, according to the degree of expression suit- al)le to the occasion ; expressing slow and tardy motions, as well as those of eagerness in pursuit: and that quickness and ferocity be expressed with such force as to give an idea of the sensations of the actors. When a figure is to throw a dart, stones, or the like, let it be seen evidently by the attitude and disposition of all the members, that such is its intention; of which there are two two examples in the opposite plates, varied both in action and power. The first in point of vigour is A. The second is B. But A will throw his weapon farther than B, because, though they seem desirous of throwing it to the same point, A ha\'ing turned his feet towards the object, while


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 77

his body is twisted and bent back the contrary way, to increase his power, returns with more velocity and force to the point to which he means to throw. But the figure B having turned his feet the same way as his body, it returns to its place with great inconvenience, and consequently with weakened powers. For in the expression of great efforts, the preparatory motions of the body must be strong and violent, twisting and bending, so that it may return with convenient ease, and by that means have a great effect. In the same manner, if a cross-bow be not strung with force, the motion of whatever it shoots will be short and without effect ; because, where there is no impulse, there can be no motion ; and? if the impulse be not ^dolent, the motion is but tardy and feeble. So a bow which is not strung has no motion ; and if it be strung, it will remain in that state till the impulse be given by ano- ther power which puts it in motion, and it will shoot with a violence equal to that which was employed in bending it. In the same manner, the man who does not twist and bend his body will have acquired no power. Therefore, after A has thrown his dart, he will find himself twisted the contrary way, viz. on the side where he has thrown ; and he will have acquired only power sufficient to serve him to return to where he was at first.


78 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

Chap. CLIV. — Of Attitudes and the Motions of the Members.

The same attitude is not to be repeated in the same picture, nor the same motion of members in the same figure, nay, not even in the hands or fin- gers.

And if the history requires a great number of figures, such as a battle, or a massacre of soldiers, in which there are but three ways of striking, \'iz. thrusting, cutting, or back-handed ; in that case you must take care, that all those who are cutting be expressed in different views ; some turning their backs, some their sides, and others be seen in front ; varjang in the same manner the three different ways of fighting, so that all the actions may have a relation to those three principles. In battles, complex motions display great art, giving spirit and animation to the whole. By complex motion is meant, for instance, that of a single figure shewing the front of the legs, and the same time the profile of the shoulder. But of this I shall treat in another place.*

Chap. CLV. — Of a single Figure separate from an historical Ch'oup.

The same motion of members should not be re-

  • Chap. xcvi. and civ.


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 79

peated in a figure which you mean to be alone ; for instance, if the figure be represented running it must not throw both hands forward ; but one for- ward and the other backward, or else it cannot run. If the right foot come forward, the right arm must go backward and the left forward, because, without such disposition and contrast of parts, it is impossible to run well. If another figure be supposed to follow this, one of its legs should be brought somewhat forward, and the other be perpendicular under the head ; the arm on the same side should pass forward. But of this we shall treat more fully in the book on motion. *

Chap. CLVI. — Oa the Attitudes of the human Figure.

A painter is to be attentive to the motions and actions of men, occasioned by some sudden accident. He must observe them on the spot, take sketches, and not wait till he wants such ex- pression, and then have it counterfeited for him ; for instance, setting a model to weep when there is no cause ; such an expression without a cause will be neither quick nor natural. But it will be of great use to have observed every action from nature, as it


• See the Life of the Author chap. xx. and ci. of the present work.


80 INVENTION OR COMPOSITION.

occurs, and then to have a model set in the same attitude to help the recollection, and find out something to the purpose, according to the subject in hand.

Chap. CLVII. — Hoiv to represent a Storm.

To form a just idea of a storm, you must con- sider it attentively in its effects. When the wind blows violently over the sea or land, it removes and carries off with it everything that is not firmly fixed to the general mass. The clouds must appear straggling and broken, carried according to the direction and the force of the wind, and blended with clouds of dust raised from the sandy shore. Branches and leaves of trees must be represented as carried along by the violence of the storm, and together with numberless other light substances, scattered in the air. Trees and grass must be bent to the ground, as if yielding to the course of the wind. Boughs must be twisted out of their natural form, with their leaves reversed and entangled. Of the figures dispersed in the pic- ture, some should appear thrown on the ground, so wrapped up in their cloaks and covered with dust, as to be scarcely distinguishable. Of those who remain on their feet, some should be sheltered by and holding fast behind some great trees, to avoid the same fate: others bending to the ground, their hands over their faces to ward off the dust 3


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 81

their hair and their clothes flying straight np at the mercy of the wind.

The high tremendous waves of the stormy sea will be covered with foaming froth ; the most sub- tle parts of which, being raised by the wind, like a thick mist, mix with the air. What vessels are seen should appear with broken cordage, and torn sails, fluttering in the wind ; some with broken masts fallen across the hulk, already on its side amidst the tempestuous waves. Some of the crew should be represented as if crying aloud for help, and clinging to the remains of the shattered vessel. Let the clouds appear as driven by tempestuous winds against the summits of lofty mountains, enveloping those mountains, and breaking and recoiling with redoubled force, like waves against a rocky shore. The air should be rendered awfully dark, by the mist, dust, and thick clouds.

Chap. CLVIII. — Hoio to compose a battle.

First, let the air exhibit a confused mixture of smoke, arising from the discharge of artillery and musquctry, and the dust raised by the horses of the combatants ; and observe, that dust being of an earthy nature, is heavy; but yet, by reason of its minute particles, it is easily impelled upAvards, and mixes with the air ; nevertheless, it naturally falls downwards again, the most subtle parts of it alone gaining any considerable degree of elevation, £ 5


82 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

and at its utmost height it is so thin and transpa- rent, as to appear nearly of the colour of the air. The smoke, thus mixing with the dusty air, forms a kind of dark cloud, at the top of which it is distin- guished from the dust by a blueish cast, the dust retaining more of its natural colour. On that part from which the light proceeds, this mixture of air, smoke, and dust, will appear much brighter than on the opposite side. Tlie more the combatants are involved in this turbulent mist, the less dis- tinctly they will be seen, and the more confused will they be in their lights and shades. Let the faces of the musketeers, their bodies, and every object near them, be tinged -with a reddish hue, even the air or cloud of dust ; in short, all that surrounds them. This red tinge you will diminish, in proportion to their distance from the primary cause. The group of figures, which appear at a distance between the spectator and the light, will form a dark mass upon a light ground ; and their legs will be more undetermined and lost as they approach nearer to the ground ; because there the dust is heavier and thicker.

If you mean to represent some straggling horses running out of the main body, introduce also some small clouds of dust, as far distant from each other as the leap of the horse, and these little clouds will become fainter, more scanty, and dif_ fused, in proportion to their distance from the


INVEXTIOX, OR COMPOSITION. 83

horse. Tliat nearest to his feet will consequently be the most determined, smallest, and the thick- est of all.

Let the air be full of arrows, in all directions ; some ascending, some falling down, and some darting straight forwards. The bidlets of the mus- ketry', though not seen, will be marked in their course by a train of smoke, which breaks through the general confusion. The figures in the fore- ground should have their hair covered ■uith dust, as also their eyebrows, and all parts liable to re- ceive it.

The victorious party will be running for- wards, their hair and other light parts flpng in the wind, their eyebrows lowered, and the motion of every member properly contrasted; for in- stance, in moving the right foot forwards, the left arm must be brought forward also. If you make any of them fallen dowTi, mark the trace of his fall on the shppery, gore-stained dust ; and where the ground is less impregnated with blood, let the print of men's feet and of horses, that have passed that way, be marked. Let there be some horses dragging the bodies of their riders, and leaving behind them a furrow, made by the body thus trailed along.

The countenances of the vanquisned will appear pale and dejected. Their eyebrows raised, and much wrinkled about the forehead and cheeks.


84 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

The tip of their noses somewhat divided from the nostrils by arched wrinkles terminating at the corner of the eyes, those wrinkles being occasi- oned by the opening and raising of the nostrils ; the upper lips turned up, discovering the teeth. Their mouths wide open, and expressive of violent lamentation. One may be seen fallen wounded on the ground, endeavouring with one hand to support his body, and covering his eyes with the other, the palm of which is turned towards the enemy. Others running away, and with open mouths seeming to cry aloud. Between the legs of the comhatants let the ground be strewed with all sorts of arms ; as broken shields, spears, swords, and the like. Many dead bodies should be introduced, some entirely covered with dust, others in part only ; let the blood, Avhich seems to issue immediately from the wound, appear of its natural colour, and running in a winding course, till, mixing with the dust, it forms a red- dish kind of mud. Some should be in the ago- nies of death ; their teeth shut, their eyes wildly staring, their fists clenched, and their legs in a distorted position. Some may appear disarmed, and beaten down by the enemy, still fighting with their fists and teeth, and endeavouring to take a passionate, though unavailing revenge. There may be also a straggling horse without a rider, vunning in wild disorder ; his mane flying in the


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 85

wind, beating down with his feet all before him and doing a deal of damage, A wounded soldier may also be seen falling to the ground, and at- tempting to cover himself with his shield, while an enemy bending over him endeavours to give him the finishing stroke. Several dead bodies should be heaped together under a dead horse Some of the conquerers, as having ceased fighting may be wiping their faces from the dirt, collected on them by the mixture of dust with the water from their eyes.

The corps de reserve will be seen advancing gaily, but cautiously, their eyebrows directed for- wards, shading their eyes with their hands to ob- serve the motions of the enemy, amidst clouds of dust and smoke, and seeming attentive to the orders of their chief. You may also make their commander holding up his staff, pushing forwards and pointing towards the place where they are wanted. A river may hkewise be introduced, with horses fording it, dashing the water about between their legs, and in the air, covering all the adjacent ground with water and foam. Not a spot is to be left without some marks of blood and carnage.

Chap. CLIX. — The Representation of an Orator and his Audience.

If you have to represent a man who is speaking to a large assembly of people, you are to consider


86 INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION.

the subject matter of his discourse, and to adapt his attitude to such subject. If he means to per- suade, let it be known by his gesture. If he is giving an explanation, deduced from several rea- sons, let him put two fingers of the right hand within one of the left, having the other two bent close, his face turned towards the audience, with the mouth half open, seeming to speak. If he is sitting, let him appear as going to raise himself up a little, and his head be forward. But if he is represented standing, let him bend his chest and his head forward towards the people.

The auditory are to appear silent and attentive, with their eyes upon the speaker, in the act of admiration. There should be some old men, with their mouths close shut, in token of approbation, and their Ups pressed together, so as to form wrin- kles at the corners of the mouth, and about the cheeks, and forming others about the forehead, by raising the eyebrows, as if struck with astonish- ment. Some others of those sitting by, should be seated with their hands within each other, round one of their knees ; some with one knee upon the other, and upon that, one hand receiving the elbow, the other supporting the chin, covered with a ve- nerable beard.

Chap. CLX. — Of demonstrative Gestures. The action by which a figure points at any thing


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 87

near, either in regard to time or situation, is to be expressed by the hand very little removed from the body. But if the same thing is far distant, the hand must also be far removed from the body, and the face of the figure pointing, must be turned to- wards those to whom he is pointing it out.

Chap. CLXL— 0/ the Attitudes of the By- standers at some remarkable Event.

All those wlio are present at some event deserv- ing notice, express their admiration, but in various manners. As when the hand of justice punishes some malefactor. If the subject be an act of de- votion, the eyes of all present should be directed towards the object of their adoration, aided by a variety of pious actions with the other members ; as at the elevation of the host at mass, and other similar ceremonies. If it be a laughable subject, or one exciting compassion and mo^ang to tears, in those cases it will not be necessary for all to have their eyes turned towards the object, but they will express their feelings by different ac- tions ; and let there be several assembled in groups, to rejoice or lament together. If the event ])e ter- rific, let the faces of those who run away from the sight, be strongly expressive of fright, -vAath vari- ous motions ; as shall be described in the tract on Motion.


88 INVENTION^ OB COMPOSITION.

Chap. CLXII. — Hoio to represent Night.

Those objects which are entirely deprived of lights are lost to the sight, as in the night ; there- fore if you mean to paint a history under those circumstances, you must suppose a large fire, and those objects that are near it to be tinged with its colour, and the nearer they are the more they will partake of it. The fire being red, all those objects which receive light from it will appear of a reddish colour, and those that are most distant from it will partake of the darkness that surrounds them. The figures which are represented before the fire will appear dark in proportion to the brightness of the fire, because those parts of them which we see, are tinged by that darkness of the night, and not by the light of the fire, which they intercept. Those that are on either side of the fire, will be half in the shade of night, and half in the red light. Those seen beyond the extent of the flames, will be all of a reddish light upon a black ground. In regard to their attitudes, let those who are nearest the fire, make screens of their hands and cloaks, against the scorching heat, with their faces turned on the contrary side, as if ready to run away from it. Tlie most remote will only be shading their eyes with their hands, as if hurt by the too great srlare.


INVENTION, OR COMPOSITION. 89

Chap. CLXIII. — Tlie Method of awakening the Mind to a Variety of Inventions.

I will not omit to introduce among these pre- cepts a new kind of speculative invention, which though apparently trifling, and almost laughable, is nevertheless of great utility in assisting the ge- nius to find variety for composition.

By looking attentively at old and smeared walls, or stones and veined marble of various colours, you may fancy that you see in them several com- positions, landscapes, battles, figures in quick mo- tion, strange countenances, and dresses, with an infinity of other objects. By these confused lines the inventive genius is excited to new exertions.

Chap. CLXIV. — Of Composition in History.

When the painter has only a single figure to re- present, he must avoid any shortening whatever, as well of any particular member, as of the whole figure, because he would have to contend with the prejudices of those who have no knowledge in that branch of the art. But in subjects of history, com- posed of many figures, shortenings may be intro- duced with great propriety, nay, they are indis- pensable, and ought to be used without reserve, as the subject may require ; particularly in battles, where of course many shortenings and contortions of figures happen, amongst such an enraged mul-


90 EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER.

titude of actors, possessed, as it were, of a brutal madness.


EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER.


Chap. CLXV. — Of expressive Motions.

Let your figures have actions appropriated to what they are intended to think or say, and these will be well learnt by imitating the deaf, who by the motion of their hands, eyes, eyebrows, and the whole body, endeavour to express the sentiments of their mind. Do not ridicule the thought of a master without a tongue teaching you an art he does not understand ; he will do it better by his expressive motions, than all the rest by their words and examples. Let then the painter, of whatever school, attend well to this maxim, and apply it to the different qualities of the figures he represents, and to the nature of the subject in which they are actors.

Chap. CLXVL — Hoio to paint Children.

Children are to be represented with quick and contorted motions, when they are sitting; but when standing, with fearful and timid motions.


EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER. 91

Chap. CLXVII. — How to represent old Men.

Old men must have slow and heavy motions ; their legs and knees must be bent when they are standing, and their feet placed parallel and wide asunder. Let them be bowed downwards, the head leaning much forward, and their arms very little extended.

Chap. CLXVIII. — How to paint old Women.

Old women, on the contrary, are to be repre- sented bold and quick, with passionate motions, like furies*. But the motions are to appear a great deal quicker in their arms than in their legs.

Chap. CLXIX. — How to jmint Women.

Women are to be represented in modest and reserved attitudes, with their knees rather close, their arms drawing near each other, or folded about the body; their heads looking downwards, and leaning a little on one side.

Chap. ChXX.—Of the Varietij of Faces. The countenances of your figures should be ex-


  • The author here speaks of unpolished nature ; and indeed it

is from such subjects only, that the genuine and characteristic operations of nature are to be learnt. It is the effect of educa- tion to correct the natural peculiarities and defects, and, by so doing, to assimilate one person to the rest of the world.


92 EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER.

pressive of their different situations : men at work, at rest, weeping, laughing, crying out, in fear, or joy, and the Hke. The attitudes also, and all the members, ought to correspond with the sentiment expressed in the faces.

Chap. ChXXl.— The Parts of the Face and their Motions.

The motions of the different parts of the face, occasioned by sudden agitations of the mind, are many. The principal of these are Laughter, Weep- ing, Calling out, Singing, either in a high or low pitch, Admiration, Anger, Joy, Sadness, Fear, Pain, and others, of which I propose to treat. First, of Laughing and Weeping, which are very similar in the motion of the mouth, the cheeks, the shutting of the eyebrows, and the space be- tween them ; as we shall explain in its place, in treating of the changes which happen in the face, hands, fingers, and all the other parts of the body, as they are affected by the different emotions of the soul ; the knowledge of which is absolutely neces- sary to a painter, or else his figures may be said to be twice dead. But it is very necessary also that he be careful not to fall into the contrary ex- treme ; giving extraordinary motions to his figures, so that in a quiet and peaceable subject, he does not seem to represent a battle, or the revellings of drunken men : but, above all, the actors in any


EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER. 93

point of history must be attentive to what they are about, or to what is going forward ; with ac- tions that denote admiration, respect, pain, suspi- cion, fear, and joy, according as the occasion, for which they are brought together, may require. Endeavour that different points of history be not placed one above the other on the same canvass, nor walls with different horizons*, as if it were a jeweller's shop, she^nng the goods in different square caskets.

Chap. CLXXII. — Laughing and Weeping.

Between the expression of laughter and that of weeping there is no difference in the motion of the features, either in the eyes, mouth, or cheeks ; only in the ruffling of the brows, which is added when weeping, but more elevated and extended in laughing. One may represent the figure weep- ing as tearing his clothes, or some other expres- sion, as various as the cause of his feeling may be ; because some weep for anger, some through fear, others for tenderness and joy, or for suspi- cion ; some for real pain and torment ; whilst others weep through compassion, or regret at the loss of some friend and near relation. These different feelings will be expressed by some with marks of despair, by others with moderation ; some only shed tears, others cry aloud, while an-

  • See chap, cxxiii.


94 EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER.

other has his face turned towards Heaven, with his hand depressed, and his fingers twisted. Some again will be full of apprehension, with their shoulders raised up to their ears, and so on, ac- cording to the above causes.

Those who weep, raise the brows, and bring them close together above the nose, forming many wrinkles on the forehead, and the comers of the mouth are turned downwards. Those who laugh have them turned upwards, and the brows open and extended.

Chap. CLXXIII.— 0/ Anger.

If you represent a man in a violent fit of anger, make him seize another by the hair, holding his head writhed down against the ground, with his knee fixed upon the ribs of his antagonist ; his right arm up, and his fist ready to strike ; his hair standing on end, his eyebrows low and straight; his teeth close, and seen at the corner of the mouth; his neck swelled, and his body covered in the abdomen with creases, occasioned by his bending over his enemy, and the excess of his passion.

Chap. CUOilY.— Despair.

The last act of despondency is, when a man is in the act of putting a period to his own exist- ence. He should be represented with a knife in one hand, with which he has already inflicted the


EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER. 95

wound, and tearing it open with the other. His garments and hair should be already torn. He will be standing ^^'ith his feet asunder, his knees a httle bent, and his body leaning forward, as if ready to fall to the ground.


96


LIGHT AND SHADOW.


Chap. CLXXV.— The Course of Study to be pursued.

The student who is desirous of making great proficiency in the art of imitating the works of Nature, should not only learn the shape of figures or other objects, and be able to delineate them with truth and precision, but he must also accompany them with their proper lights and shadows, accord- ing to the situation in which those objects appear.

Chap. CLXXVI. — Which of the two is the most useful Knowledge, the Outlines of Figures, or that of Light and Shadotv.

The knowledge of the outline is of most con- sequence, and yet may be acquired to great cer- tainty by dint of study; as the outUnes of the different parts of the human figure, particularly those which do not bend, are invariably the same. But the knowledge of the situation, quality, and quantity of shadows, being infinite, requires the most extensive study.


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 97

Chap. CLXXVII. — WJdch is the most important^ the Shadows or Outlines in Painting. It requires much more observation and study to arrive at perfection in the shadowing of a pic- ture, than in merely drawing the hnes of it. The proof of this is, that the Unes may be traced upon a veil or a flat glass placed between the eye and the object to be imitated. But that cannot be of any use in shadowing, on account of the infinite gra- dation of shades, and the blending of them, which does not allow of any precise termination ; and most frequently they are confused, as will be de- monstrated in another place.*

Chap. CLXXVIII. — What is a Painter's first Aim and Object. The first object of a painter is to make a sim- ple flat surface appear like a relievo, and some of its parts detached from the ground ; he who excels all others in that part of the art, deserves tlie greatest praise. This perfection of the art depends on the correct distribution of lights and shades, called Chiaroscuro. If the painter then avoids shadows, he may be said to avoid the glory of the art, and to render his work despicable to real connoisseurs, for the sake of acquiring the esteem of vulgar and ignorant admirers of fine colours, who never have any knowledge of relievo.

  • See chap, cclxiv.

F


98 LIGHT AND SHADOW.

Chap. CLXXIX. — The Difference of Superficies, in regard to Painting. •

Solid bodies are of two sorts : the one has the surface curvilinear, oval, or spherical ; the other has several surfaces, or sides producing angles, either regular or irregular. Spherical, or oval bodies, will always appear detached from their ground, though they are exactly of the same colour. Bodies also of diiferent sides and angles will always detach, because they are always disposed so as to produce shades on some of their sides, which cannot happen to a plain superficies.*

Chap. CLXXX. — Hoiv a Painter may become universal.

The painter who wishes to be universal, and please a variety of judges, must unite in the same composition, objects susceptible of great force in the shadows, and great sweetness in the manage- ment of them ; accounting, however, in every in- stance, for such boldness and softenings.

Chap. CLXXXI. — Accuracy ought to be learnt before Dispatch iti the Execution.

If you wish to make good and useful studies, use great deliberation in your drawings, observe

  • See chapter cclxvii.


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 9^

well among the lights, which, and how many, hold the first rank in point of brightness ; and so among the shadows, which are darker than others, and in what manner they Ijlend together ; com- pare the quality and quantity of one with the other, and obser\'e to what part they are directed. Be careful also in your outUnes, or di\nsions of the members. Remark well what quantity of parts are to be on one side, and what on the other ; and where they are more or less apparent, or broad, or slender. Lastly, take care that the shadows and lights be united, or lost in each other ; with- out any hard strokes or lines ; as smoke loses itself in the air, so are your lights and shadows to pass from the one to the other, without any appa- rent separation.

When you have acquired the habit, and formed your hand to accuracy, quickness of execution will come of itself,*

Chap. CLXXXII. — Hoiv the Painter is to place himself in regard to the Light, and his Model.

Let A B be the window, M the centre of it, C the model. The best situation for the painter will be a little sideways, between the window and his model, as D, so that he may see his object partly in the light and partly in the shadow.

  • Sir Joshua RejTiolds frequently inculcated these precepts in

his lectures, and indeed they cannot be too often enforced.

F 2


100


LIGHT AND SHADOW.



Chap. CLXXXIIL— 0/ the best Ught.

The light from on high, and not too powerful, will be found the best calculated to shew the parts to advantage.

Chap. Ch^X.Xl\ .— Of Drawing bij Candle- light.

To this artificial light apply a paper blind, and vou will see the shadows undetermined and soft.


Chap. CLXXXV. — Of those Painters ivho draw at Home from one Light, and afterwards adapt their studies to another Situation in the Country, and a different Light.

It is a great error in some painters who draw a figure from nature at home, by any particular light, and afterwards make use of that drawing in a picture representing an open countr^^ which receives the general light of the sky, where the surrounding air gives light on all sides. This


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 101

])ainter woxild put dark shadows, where Nature would either produce none, or, if any, so very faint as to be almost imperceptible ; and he would throw reflected hghts where it is impossible there should be any.

Chap. CLXXXVI. — How high the Light should he in drawing from Nature.

To paint well from Nature, your window should l)e to the North, that the lights may not vary. If it be to the South, you must have paper blinds, that the sun, in going round, may not alter the shadows. The situation of the light should be such as to produce vipon the ground a shadow from your model as long as that is high.

Chap. CLXXXYll. —TFhat Light the Painter must make Use of to give most Relief to his Figures.

The figures which receive a particular light show more relief than those which receive an universal one ; because the particular light occasions some reflexes, which proceed from the light of one ob- ject upon the shadows of another, and help to detach it from the dark ground. But a figure placed in front of a dark and large space, and re- ceiving a particular light, can receive no reflexion from any other objects, and nothing is seen of the figure but what the light strikes on, the rest being


102 LIGHT AND SHADOW.

blended and lost in the darkness of the back ground. This is to be applied only to the imita- tion of night subjects with very little light.

Chap. ChXXXYlll.— Advice to Painters.

Be very careful, in painting, to observe, that be- tween the shadows there are other shadows, almost imperceptible, both for darkness and shape ; and this is proved by the third proposition/ which says, that the surfaces of globular or convex bodies have as great a variety of lights and shadows as the bodies that surround them have.

Chap. CLXXXIX.— 0/ Shadoivs, Those shadows which in Nature are undeter- mined, and the extremities of which can hardly be perceived, are to be copied in your painting in the same manner, never to be precisely finished, but left confused and blended. This apparent neglect will show great judgment, and be the ingenious result of your observation of Nature.

Chap. CXC. — Of the Kind of Light proper for drawing from Relievos, or from Nature.

Lights separated from the shadows with too much precision, have a very bad eifect. In order,

  • Probably this would have formed a part of his intended Trea-

tise on Light and Shadow, but no such proposition occurs in the present work.


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 103

therefore, to avoid this inconA^enience, if the object be in the open country, you need not let your figures be illumined by the sun ; but may suppose some transparent clouds interposed, so that the sun not being visible, the termination of the sha- dows will be also imperceptible and soft.

Chap. CXCI. — TVhether the Light should be ad- mitted in Front or sideways ; and which is most pleasing and graceful.

The light admitted in front of heads situated opposite to side walls that are dark, will cause them to have great relievo, particularly if the light be placed high -, and the reason is, that the most pro- minent parts of those faces are illumined by the general light striking them in front, which light produces very faint shadows on the part Avhere it strikes ; but as it turns towards the sides, it begins to participate of the dark shadows of the room, which grow darker in proportion as it sinks into them. Besides, when the light comes from on high, it does not strike on every part of the face alike, but one part produces great shadows upon another ; as the eyebrows, which deprive the whole sockets of the eyes of light. The nose keeps it off from great part of the mouth, and the chin from the neck, and such other parts. This, by concen- trating the light upon the most projecting parts, produces a very great relief.


lOJ LIGHT AXD SHADOW.

Chap. CXCll.— Of the Difference of Lights according to the Situation.

A small light will cast large and determined shadows upon the surrounding bodies. A large light, on the contrar}^, will cast small shadows on them, and they will be much confused in their ter- mination. When a small but strong light is sur- rounded by a broad but weaker light, the latter will appear like a demi-tint to the other, as the sky round the sun. And the bodies which receive tlie light from the one, will serve as demi-tints to those which receive the hght from the other.

Chap. CXCIII. — How to distribute the Light on Figures.

Tlie lights are to be distributed according to the natural situation you mean your figures should occupy. If you suppose them in sunshine, the shades must be dark, the hghts broad and ex- tended, and the shadows of all the surrounding objects distinctly marked upon the ground. If seen in a gloomy day, there wiU be very Httle dif- ference between the hghts and shades, and no shadows at the feet. If the figures be represented within doors, the lights and shadows will again l)e distinctly divided, and produce shadows on the ground. But if you suppose a paper blind at the window, and the walls painted white, the effect


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 105

will be the same as in a gloomy day, when tlie lights and shadows have little difference. If the figures are enlightened by the fire, the lights must be red and powerful, the shadows dark, and the shadows upon the ground and upon the walls must be precise ; observing that they spread wider as they go off from the body. If the figures be en- lightened, partly by the sky and partly by the fire, that side which receives the light from the sky Avill be the brightest, and on the other side it will be reddish, somewhat of the colour of the fire. Above all, contrive that your figures receive a broad light, and that from above ; particularly in portraits, because the people we see in the street receive all the light from above ; and it is curious to observe, that there is not a face ever so well known amongst your acquaintance, but woidd be recognised with difficulty, if it were enlightened from beneath.

Chap. CXCIV.— 0///iC Beauhj of Faces.

You must not mark any muscles with hardness

of line, but let the soft light glide upon them, and

terminate imperceptibly in delightful shadows :

from this will arise grace and beauty to the face.

Chap. CXCV. — How, in drawing a Face, to give it Grace, by the Management of Light and Shade.

A face placed in the dark part of a room, ac- F 5


106 LIGHT AND SHADOW.

quires great additional grace by means of light and shadow. The shadowed part of the face blends with the darkness of the ground, and the light part receives an increase of brightness from the open air, the shadows on this side becoming almost in- sensible; and from this augmentation of light and shadow, the face has much relief, and acquires great beauty.

Chap. CXCVI. — Hoio to give Grace and Relief to Faces.

In streets running towards the west, when the sun is in the meridian, and the walls on each side so high that they cast no reflexions on that side of the bodies which is in shade, and the sky is not too bright, we find the most advantageous situa- tion for giving relief and grace to figures, particu- larly to faces; because both sides of the face will ])articipate of the shadows of the walls. The sides of the nose and the face towards the west, will be light, and the man whom we supposed placed at the entrance, and in the middle of the street, will see all the parts of that face, which are before him, perfectly illumined, while both sides of it, towards the walls, will be in shadow. What gives addi- tional grace is, that these shades do not appear cutting, hard, or dry, but softly blended and lost in each other. The reason of it is, that the light which is spread all over in the air, strikes also the


LIGHT AND SHADOW.


107


pavement of the street, and reflecting upon the shady part of the face, it tinges that slightly with the same hue : while the great light which comes from above being confined by the tops of houses, strikes on the face with different points, almost to the very beginning of the shadows under the pro- jecting parts of the face. It diminishes by de- grees the strength of them, increasing the light till it comes upon the chin, where it terminates, and loses itself, blending softly into the shades on all sides. For instance, if such light were A E, the Une F E would give light even to the bottom of the nose. The line C F will give light only to the under lip; bvit the line A H would extend the shadow to all the under parts of the face, and under the chin.

In this situation the nose receives a very strong light from all the points A B C D E.



108 LIGHT AND SHADOW.

Chap. CXCVII. — Of the Termmation of Bodies upon each other.

When a body, of a cylindrical or convex sur- face, terminates upon another body of the same colour, it will appear darker on the edge, than the body upon which it terminates. And any flat body, adjacent to a white surface, will appear very dark; but ujion a dark ground it will appear lighter than any other part, though the lights be equal.

Chap. CXCVIII. — Of theBack-grounds of painted Objects.

The ground which surrounds the figures in any painting, ought to be darker than the light part of those figures, and lighter than the shadowed part.

Chap. CXCIX. — Hoiv to detach and bring fonvard Figures out of their Back-ground.

If your figure be dark, place it on a light ground; if it be light, upon a dark ground; and if it be partly light and partly dark, as is generally the case, contrive that the dark part of the figure be upon the fight part of the ground, and the liglit side of it against the dark.*

Chap. CC. — Of proper Back-grounds. It is of the greatest importance to consider well

  • See chapiters cc. and ccxix.


LIGHT AND SHADOW.


109


the nature of back-grounds, upon which any opake body is to be placed. In order to detach it pro- perly, you should place the light part of such opake body against the dark part of the back-ground, and the dark parts on a light ground;* as in the cut.f



Chap. CCI. — Of the general Liyht diffused over Figures.

In compositions of many figures and animals, observe, that the parts of these different ol)jects ought to be darker in proportion as they are lower,

  • See chap. ccix.

t This cannot be taken as an absolute rule ; it must be left in a great measure to the judgment of the painter. For much grace- ful softness and grandeur is acquired, sometimes, by blending the lights of the figures with the light part of tlie ground ; and so of the shadows; as Leonardo himself has observed in chapters cxciv. cxcv. and Sir Joshua Reynolds has often put in practice with success.


110


LIGHT AND SHADOW.


and as they are nearer the middle of the groups, though they are all of an uniform colour. This is necessar)^, because a smaller proportion of the sky (from which all bodies are illuminated) can give light to the lower spaces between these different figures, than to the upper parts of the spaces. It is proved thus : A B C D is that portion of the sky which gives light to all the objects beneath ; M and N are the bodies M'hich occupy the space S T R H, in which it is evidently perceived, that the point F, receiving the hght only from the portion of the sky C D, has a smaller quantity of it than the point E which receives it from the whole space A B (a larger portion than C D) ; therefore it will be lighter in E than in F.

J)



LIGHT AND SHADOW.


HI


Chap. CCII. — Of those Parts in Shadoivs which appear the darkest at a Distance.

The neck, or any other part which is raised straight upwards, and has a projection over it, will he darker than the perpendicular front of that projection ; and this projecting part will be lighter, in proportion as it presents a larger sur- face to the light.



For instance, the recess A receives no light from any part of the sky G K, Ijut B begins to receive the light from the part of the sky H K, and C from G K ; and the point D receives the whole of F K. Therefore the chest will be as hght as the


112 LIGHT AND SHADOW.

forehead, nose, and chin. But what I have par- ticularly to recommend, in regard to faces, is, that you observe well those different qualities of shades which are lost at different distances (while there remain only the first and principal spots or strokes of shades, such as those of the sockets of the eyes, and other similar recesses, which are always dark), and at last the whole face becomes ob- scured; because the greatest lights (l)eing small in proportion to the demi-tints) are lost. The quality, therefore, and quantity of the principal lights and shades are by means of great distance blended together into a general half-tint ; and this is the reason why trees and other objects are found to be in appearance darker at some dis- tance than they are in reality, when nearer to the eye. But then the air, which interposes between the objects and the eye, will render them hght again by tinging them with azure, rather in the shades than in the lights ; for the lights will pre- serve the truth of the different colours much longer.

Chap. CCIII. — Of the Eye viewing the Folds of Draperies surroundiny a Figure.

The shadows between the folds of a drapery surrounding the parts of the human body will be darker as the deep hollows where the shadows are generated are more directly opposite the eye.


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 113

This is to be observed only when the eye is placed between the light and the shady part of the figure.

Chap. CCIV.— 0/ the Relief of Figures remote from the Eye.

Any opake body appears less relieved in pro- portion as it is farther distant from the eye ; be- cause the air, interposed between the eye and such body, being lighter than the shadow of it, it tarnishes and weakens that shadow, lessens its power, and consequently lessens also its relief.

CiiAP. CCV. — Of Outlines of Objects on the Side toivards the Light.

The extremities of any object on the side which receives the light, will appear darker if upon a lighter ground, and lighter if seen upon a darker ground. But if such body be flat, and seen upon a ground equal in point of light with itself, and of the same colour, such boundaries, or outlines, will be entirely lost to the sight.*

Chap. CCVI. — Hoiv to make Objects detach from their Ground, that is to say, from the Surface on ivhich they are painted.

Objects contrasted with a light ground will appear much more detached than those which are

  • See chap, cclxv.


114 CONTRASTE AND EFFECT.

placed against a dark one. The reason is, that if you wish to give rehef to your figures, you will make those parts which are the farthest from the light, participate the least of it ; therefore they will remain the darkest, and every distinction of outhne would be lost in the general mass of sha- dows. But to give it grace, roundness, and effect, those dark shades are always attended by re- flexes, or else they would either cut too hard upon the ground, or stick to it, by the similarity of shade, and relieve the less as the ground is dark- er ; for at some distance nothing would be seen but the light parts, therefore your figures would appear mutilated of all that remains lost in the back-ground.


CONTRASTE AND EFFECT.


Chap. CC\ll.—A Precept.

Figures vnW have more grace, placed in the open and general light, than in any particular or small one; because the powerful and extended light will surround and embrace the objects : and works done in that kind of light appear pleasant


CONTRASTE AND EFFECT. 115

and graceful when placed at a distance*, while those which are drawn in a narrow light will re- ceive great force of shadow, but will never appear at a great distance, but as painted objects.

Chap. CCVIII. — Of the Interposition of transpa- rent Bodies between the Eye and the Object.

The greater the transparent interposition is be- tween the eye and the object, the more the colour of that object Avill participate of, or be changed into that of the transparent medium ■\.

When an opake Ijody is situated between the eye and the luminary, so that the central line of the one passes also through the centre of the other, that object will be entirely deprived of light.

Chap. CCIX. — Of proper Back-grounds for Figures.

As we find by experience, that all bodies are surrounded by lights and shadows, I would have the painter to accommodate that part which is enlightened, so as to terminate upon something dark ; and to manage the dark parts so that they may terminate on a light ground. This will be of

  • See chap, cxcvi.

t He means here to say, that in proportion as the body inter- posed between the eye and the object is more or less transpa- rent, the greater or less quantity of the colour of the body inter- posed will be communicated to the object.


116 REFLEXES.

great assistance in detaching and bringing out his figures.*

Chap. CCX. — Of Back-grounds.

To give a great effect to figures, you must op- pose to a hght one a dark ground, and to a dark figure a hght ground, contrasting white with black, and black with white. In general, all con- traries give a particular force and brilliancy of effect by their opposition.f


REFLEXES.


Ch AP. CCXI. — Of Objects placed on a light Ch'ound, and why such a Practice is useful in Painting.

When a darkish body terminates upon a light ground, it will appear detached from that ground ; because all opake bodies of a curved surface are not only dark on that side which receives no light, and consequently very different from the ground ; but even that side of the curved surface which is enlightened, will not carry its principal light to

  • See the note to chap. cc.

f See the preceding chapter, and chap. cc.


REFLEXES. 117

the extremities, but have between the ground and the principal light a certain demi-tint, darker than either the ground or that light.

Chap. CCXIL— 0/ the different Effects of White, according to the Difference of BacTc-grounds.

Any thing white will appear whiter, by being opposed to a dark ground ; and, on the contrary, darker upon a light ground. This we learn from observing snow as it falls ; while it is descending it appears darker against the sky, than when we see it against an open window, which (owing to the darkness of the inside of the house) makes it appear very white. Observe also, that snow ap- pears to fall \ery quick and in a great quantity when near the eye ; but when at some distance, it seems to come down slowly, and in a smaller quantity.*

CiiAP. CCXIII. — Of Reverberation.

Reverberations are produced by all bodies of a bright nature, that have a smootli and tolerably hard surface, which, repelling the light it receives, makes it rebound like a foot-ball against the first object opposed to it.


  • The appearance of motion is lessened according to the dis-

tance, in the same proportion as objects diminish in size.


118 REFLEXES.

Chap. CCXIV. — Where there cannot be any Reverberation of Light.

The surfaces of hard bodies are surrounded by various quahties of hght and shadow. The lights are of two sorts ; one is called original, the other derivative. The original light is that which comes from the sun, or the brightness of fire, or else from the air. The derivative is a reflected light. But to return to our definition, I say, there can be no reflexion on that side which is turned towards any dark body; such as roofs either high or low, shrubs, grass, wood, either dry or green ; because, though every individual part of those objects be turned towards the original light, and struck by it ; yet the quantity of shadow which every one of these parts produces upon the others, is so great, that, upon the whole, the light, not forming a com- pact mass, loses its effect, so that those objects cannot reflect any light upon the opposite bodies.

Chap. CCXV. — In what Part the Reflexes have more or less Brightness.

The reflected lights will be more or less appa- rent or bright, in proportion as they are seen against a darker or fainter ground ; because if the ground be darker than the reflex, then this reflex will appear stronger on account of the great diffe- rence of colour. But, on the contrary, if this re-


REFLEXES. 11^

flexion has behind it a ground Ughter than itself, it will appear dark, in comparison to the bright- ness which is close to it, and therefore it will be hardly perceptible.*

Chap. CCXVI. — Of the reflected Lights which surround the Shadows. Tlie reflected lights which strike upon the midst of shadows, \\all brighten up or lessen their obscu- rity in proportion to the strength of those lights, and their proximity to those shadows. Many painters neglect this observation, while others at- tend to and deduce their practice from it. This difference of opinion and practice di\'ides the sen- timents of artists, so that they blame each other for not thinking and acting as they themselves do. The best way is to steer a middle course, and not to admit of any reflected light, but when the cause of it is evident to every eye ; and vice versa, if you introduce none at all, let it appear evident that there was no reasonable cause for it. In doing so, you will neither be totally blamed nor praised by the variet)'- of opinion, which, if not proceeding from entire ignorance, will ensure to you the approbation of both parties.

Chap. CCXVII. — IVhere Reflexes are to he most apparent. Of all reflected lights, that is to be tlie most ap-

  • See chap, ccxvii. and ccxix.


120 REFLEXES.

parent^ bold, and precise, which detaches from the darkest ground ; and, on the contrary, that which is upon a hghter ground will be less apparent. And this proceeds from the contraste of shades, by which the faintest makes the dark ones appear still darker ; so in contrasted lights, the brightest cause the others to appear less bright than they really are.*

Chap. CCXYlll.—TFhat Part of a Reflex is to he the lightest.

That part will be the brightest which receives the reflected light between angles the most nearly equal. For example, let N be the luminary, and A B the illuminated part of the object, reflecting the light over all the shady part of the concavity opposite to it. The light which reflects upon F will be placed between equal angles. But E at the base will not be reflected by equal angles, as it is evident that the angle E A B is more obtuse than the angle E B A. The angle A F B, however, though it is between angles of less quality than the angle E, and has a common base B A, is between angles more nearly equal than E, therefore it will be lighter in F than in E; and it will also be brighter, because it is nearer to the part which

  • See chap, ccxv. and ccxix.


REFLEXES. 121

gives them light, According to the 6th rule,* which says, that part of the body is to be the hghtest, which is nearest to the luminary.


Chap. CCXIX. — Of the Termination of Reflexes on their Grounds.

The termination of a reflected light on a ground lighter than that reflex, wiU not be perceivable ; but if such a reflex terminates upon a ground darker than itself, it will be plainly seen ; and the more so in proportion as that ground is darker, and vice versa.\

Chap. CCXX. — Of double and treble Reflexions of Light.

Double reflexes are stronger than single ones,

  • This was intended to constitute a part of some book of Per-

spective, which we have not ; but the rule here referred to will be found in chap cccx. of the present work.

t See chap. ccxv. and ccxvii.

G


122


IC£1* L£iX£jS« 


and the shadows which interpose between the com- mon light and these reflexes are very faint. For instance, let A be the luminous body, A N, A S, are the direct rays, and S N the parts which re- ceive the light from them. O and E are the places enhghtened by the reflexion of that light in those parts. A N E is a single reflex, but A N O, A S O is the double reflex. The single reflex is that which proceeds from a single light, but the double reflexion is produced by two different lights. The single one E is produced by the light striking on B D, while the double one O proceeds from the enlightened bodies B D and D R co-operating to- gether ; and the shadows which are between N O and S O will be very faint.



REFLEXES. 123

Chap. CCXXI. — Reflexes in the Water, and particularly those of the Air.

The only portion of air that will be seen re- flected in the water, will be that which is reflected by the surface of the water to the eye between equal angles ; that is to say, the angle of incidence must be equal to the angle of reflexion.


o 2


124


COLOURS AND COLOURING.


COLOURS.

Chap. CCXXIL — WJiat Surface is best calculated to receive most Colours,

White is more capable of receiving all sorts of colours, than the surface of any body whatever, that is not transparent. To prove it, we shaU say, that any void space is capable of receiving what another space, not void, cannot receive. In the same manner, a white surface, like a void space, being destitute of any colour, wiU be fittest to re- ceive such as are conveyed to it from any other enlightened body, and will participate more of the colour than black can do; which latter, like a broken vessel, is not able to contain any thing.

Chap. CCXXIIL — What Surface ivill shew most perfectly its true Colour.

That opake body will show its colour more per- fect and beautiful, which has near it another body of the same colour.


COLOURS. 125

Chap. CCXXIV. — On lohat Surfaces the true Colour is least apparent.

Polished and glossy surfaces show least of their genuine colour. This is exemplified in the grass of the fields, and the leaves of trees, which, being smooth and glossy, Avill reflect the colour of the sun, and the air, where they strike, so that the parts which receive the light do not show their natural colour.

Chap. CCXXV. — What Surfaces show most of their true and genuine Colour.

Those objects that are the least smooth and po- lished shew their natural colours best ; as we see in cloth, and in the leaves of such grass or trees as are of a woolly nature ; which, having no lustre, are exhibited to the eye in their true natural co- lour ; unless that colour happen to be confused by that of another body casting on them reflexions of an opposite colour, such as the redness of the setting sun, when all the clouds are tinged with its colour.

Chap. CCXXVL— 0/Me Mixture of Colours.

Although the mixture of colours may be ex- tended to an infinite variety, almost impossible to be described, I will not omit touching slightly upon it, setting down at first a certain number of simple


126 • COLOURS.

colours to serve as a foundation, and with each of these mixing one of the others ; one mth one, then two with two, and three with three, proceeding in this manner to the full mixture of aU the colours together : then I would begin again, mixing two of these colours with tAvo others, and three with three, four with four, and so on to the end. To these two colours we shall put three ; to these three add three more, and then six, increasing always in the same proportion.

I call those simple colours, which are not com- posed, and cannot be made or supphed by any mixture of other colours. Black and White are not reckoned among colours ; the one is the repre- sentative of darkness, the other of light : that is, one is a simple privation of light, the other is light itself. Yet I wiU not omit mentioning them, be- cause there is nothing in painting more useful and necessary ; since painting is but an effect produced by lights and shadows, viz. chiara-scuro. After Black and White come Blue and Yellow, then Green, and Tawny or Umber, and then Purple and Red. These eight colours are all that Nature produces. With these I begin my mixtures, first Black and White, Black and Yellow, Black and Red ; then Yellow and Red : but I shall treat more at length of these mixtures in a separate work,* which will be of great utility, nay very ne-

  • No such work was ever published, nor, for any thing that

"Vf^ars, ever written.


COLOURS. 127

cessary. I shall place this subject between theory and practice.

Chap. CCXXVII. — Of the Colours produced by the Mixture of other Colours, called secondary Colours.

The first of all simple colours is White, though philosophers will not acknowledge either White or Black to be colours; because the first is the cause, or the receiver of colours, the other totally deprived of them. But as j)ainters cannot do without either, we shall place them among the others; and according to this order of things, White will be the first, Yellow the second. Green the third. Blue the fourth, Red the fifth, and Black the sixth. We shall set down White for the re- presentative of light, without which no colour can be seen; Yellow for the earth; Green for water; Blue for air; Red for fire; and Black for total darkness.

If you wish to see by a short process the variety of all the mixed, or composed colours, take some coloured glasses, and, through them, look at al^ the country round : you will find that the colour of each object will be altered and mixed with the colour of the glass through which it is seen ; ob- serve which colour is made better, and which is hurt by the mixture. If the glass be yellow, the colour of the objects may either be improved, or


128 COLOURS.

greatly impaired by it. Black and White will be most altered, while Green and YeUow will be meliorated. In the same manner you may go through all the mixtures of colours, which are in- finite. Select those which are new and agreeable to the sight ; and following the same method you may go on with two glasses, or three, till you have found what will best answer your purpose.

Chap. CCXXVIII.— 0/ Verdegris.

This green, which is made of copper, though it be mixed with oil, will lose its beauty, if it be not varnished immediately. It not only fades, but, if washed with a sponge and pure water only, it will detach from the ground upon which it is painted, particularly in damp weather; because verdegris is produced by the strength of salts, which easily dissolve in rainy weather, but still more if washed with a wet sponge.

Chap. CCXXIX. — How to increase the Beauty of Verdegris.

If you mix with the Verdegris some Caballine Aloe, it will add to it a great degree of beauty. It would acquire still more from Saffron, if it did not fade. The quality and goodness of this Aloe will be proved by dissolving it in warm Brandy. Sup- posing the Verdigris has already been used, and the part finished, you may then glaze it thinly


COLOURS. 129

with this dissolved Aloe, and it will produce a very fine colour. This Aloe may be ground also in oil ty itself, or with the Verdegris, or any other co- lour, at pleasure.

Chap. CCXXX. — Hov) to paint a Picture that will last almost for ever.

After you have made a drawing of your in- tended picture, prepare a good and thick priming with pitch and brickdust well pounded; after which give it a second coat of white lead and Naples yellow; then, having traced your drawing upon it, and painted your picture, varnish it with clear and thick old oil, and stick it to a flat glass, or crystal, with a clear varnish. Another method, which may be better, is, instead of the primipg of pitch and brickdust, take a flat tile well vitrified, then apply the coat of white and Naples yellow, and all the rest as before. But before the glass is applied to it, the painting must be perfectly dried in a stove, and varnished with nut oil and amber, or else ^vith purified nut oil alone, thickened in the sun.*

  • The French translation of 17 10' has a note on this chapter,

saying, that the invention of enamel painting found out since the time of Leonardo da Vinci, would better answer to the title of this chapter, and also be a better method of painting. I must beg leave, however, to dissent from this opinion, as the two kiads of painting are so different that they cannot be compared. Leo- nardo treats of oil painting, but the other is vitrification. Leo- nardo is known to have spent a great deal of time in experiments, of which this is a specimen, and it may appear ridiculous to the

G 5


I.JO COLOURS.

Chap. CCXXXI. — The Mode of painting on Canvass, or Linen Cloth *.

Stretch your canvass upon a frame, then give it a coat of weak size, let it dry, and draw your outlines upon it. Paint the flesh colours first; and while it is still fresh or moist, paint also the shadows, well softened and blended together. The flesh colour may be made with white, lake, and Naples yellow. The shades with black, um- ber, and a little lake ; you may, if you please, use black chalk. After you have softened this first coat, or dead colour, and let it dry, you may re- touch over it with lake and other colours, and gum water that has been a long while made and kept liquid, because in that state it becomes better, and does not leave any gloss. Again, to make the shades darker, take the lake and gum as above, and ink*; and with this you may shade or glaze many colours, because it is transparent; such as azure, lake, and several others. As for

practitioners of more modern date, as he does not enter more fully into a minute description of the materials, or the mode of employing them. The principle laid down in the text appears to me to be simply this : to make the oil entirely evaporate from the colours by the action of fire, and afterwards to prevent the action of the air by the means of a glass which in itself is an excellent principle, but not applicable, any more than enamel painting, to large works.

  • It is evident that distemper or size painting is here meant

t Indian ink.


COLOURS. 131

the lights, you may retouch or glaze them shghtly with gum water and pure lake, particularly vermi lion.

Chap. CCXXXlh— Of lively and beautiful Colours.

For those colours which you mean should ap- pear beautiful, prepare a ground of pure white. This is meant only for transparent colours : as for those that have a body, and are opake, it matters not what ground they have, and a white one is of no use. This is exemphfied by painted glasses ; when placed between the eye and clear air, they exhibit most excellent and beautiful colours, which is not the case, when they have thick air, or some opake body behind them.

Chap. CCXXXIII. — Of transparent Colours.

When a transparent colour is laid upon ano- ther of a different nature, it produces a mixed colour, different from either of the simple ones which compose it. This is observed in the smoke coming out of a chimney, which, when passing before the black soot, appears blueisli, but as it ascends against the blue of the sky, it changes its appearance into a reddish brown. So the colour lake laid on blue will turn it to a violet colour ; yellow upon blue turns to green ; saffron upon white becomes yellow; white scumbled upon a


132 COLOURS,

dark ground appears blue, and is more or less beautiful, as the white and the ground are more or less pure.

Chap. CCXXXYV.—In what Part a Colour will appear in its greatest beauty.

We are to consider here in what part any co- lour will shew itself in its most perfect purity; whether in the strongest light or deepest shadow, in the demi-tint, or in the reflex. It would be necessary to determine first, of what colour we mean to treat, because different colours differ materially in that respect. Black is most beau- tiful in the shades ; white in the strongest light ; blue and green in the half-tint; yellow and red in the principal light ; gold in the reflexes ; and lake in the half-tint.

Chap. CCXXXV. — How any Colour without a Gloss, is more beautiful in the Lights than in the Shades.

All objects which have no gloss, shew their colours better in the light than in the shadow, because the light vivifies and gives a true know- ledge of the nature of the colour, while the sha- dows lower, and destroy its beauty, preventing the discovery of its nature. If, on the contrary, black be more beautiful in the shadows, it is be- cause black is not a colour.


COLOURS.


138


Chap. CCXXXVI.— 0/ the Appearance of Colours.

The lighter a colour is in its nature, the more so it will appear when removed to some distance; but with dark colours it is quite the reverse.

Chap. CCXXXMll.—What Part of a Colour is to be the most beautiful.

If A be the light, and B the object receiving it in a direct line, E cannot receive that light, but only the reflexion from B, which we shall suppose to be red. In that case, the light it produces being red, it will tinge with red the object E; and if E happen to ])e also red before, you will see that colour increase in beauty, and appear redder than B ; l)ut if E M^ere yellow, you will see a new colour, participating of the red and the yellow.


A.^



134 COLOURS.

Chap. CCXXXVIII.— ^Aa/ the beauty of a Co- lour is to be found in the Lights.

As the quality of colours is discovered to the eye by the light, it is natural to conclude, that where there is most light, there also the true qua- lity of the colour is to be seen ; and where there is most shadow the colour will participate of, and be tinged with the colour of that shadow. Re- member then to shew the true quality of the colour in the light parts only*.

Chap. CCXXXIX.— 0/ Colours.

The colour which is between the light and the shadow will not be so beautiful as that which is in the full light. Therefore the chief beauty of colours will be found in the principal lights f-

Chap. CCXL. — No Object appears in its trite Colour, unless the Light which strikes upon it be of the same Colour.

This is very observable in draperies, where the light folds casting a reflexion, and throwing a light on other folds opposite to them, make them appear in their natural colour. The same eflfect is produced by gold leaves casting their light reci- procally on each other. The eflfect is quite con-

  • This rule is not without exception : see chap, ccxxxjt.

t See chap, ccxxxviii.


COLOURS. 135

trary if the light be received from an object of a different colour*.

Chap. CCXLI. — Of the Colour of Shadows.

The colour of the sliadows of an object can never be pure if the body which is opposed to these shadows be not of the same colour as that on which they are produced. For instance, if in a room, the walls of which are green, I place a figure clothed in blue, and receiving the light from another blue object, the light part of that figure will be of a beautiful blue, but the shadows of it will become dingy, and not like a true shade of that beautiful blue, because it will be corrupted by the reflexions from the green wall ; and it would be still worse if the walls were of a darkish brown.

Chap. CCXLIL— 0/ Colours.

Colours placed in shadow will preserve more or less of their original beauty, as they are more or less immersed in the shade. But colours si- tuated in a light space will shew their natural beauty in proportion to the brightness of tliat light. Some say, that there is as great variety in the colours of shadows, as in the colours of ob- jects shaded by them. It may be answered, that

• Sec chap, ccxxxvii.


136 COLOURS.

colours placed in shadow will shew less variety amongst themselves as the shadows are darker. We shall soon convince ourselves of this truth, if, from a large square, we look through the open door of a church, where pictures, though enriched with a variety of colours, appear all clothed in darkness.

Chap. CCXLIIL — Whether it be possible for all Colours to appear alike by means of the same Shadow.

It is very possible that all the different colours may be changed into that of a general shadow ; as is manifest in the darkness of a cloudy night, in which neither the shape nor colour of bodies is distinguished. Total darkness being nothing but a privation of the primitive and reflected lights, by which the form and colour of bodies are seen ; it is evident, that the cause being removed the effect ceases, and the objects are entirely lost to the sight.

Chap. CCXLIV. — Why White is not reckoned among the Colours.

White is not a colour, but has the power of receiving all the other colours. When it is placed in a high situation in the country, all its shades


COLOURS. 137

are azure ; according to the fourth proposition*, which says, that the surface of any opake body participates of the colour of any other body send- ing the hglit to it. Therefore white being de- prived of the light of the sun by the interposition of any other body, \at11 remain white ; if exposed to the sun on one side, and to the open air on the other, it -u-ill participate both of the colour of the sun and of the air. That side which is not opposed to the sun, will be shaded of the colour of the air. And if this white were not surrounded by green fields all the way to the horizon, nor could receive any light from that horizon, with- out doubt it would appear of one simple and uni- form colour, viz, that of the air.

Chap. CCXLV.— 0/ Colours.

The light of the fire tinges every thing of a red- dish yellow ; but this will hardly appear evident, if we do not make the comparison with the day- light. Towards the close of the evening this is easily done ; but more certainly after the morning twilight ; and the difference will be clearly distin- guished in a dark room, when a httle ghmpse of daylight strikes upon any part of the room, and

• See chapters ccxlvii. ccLxxiv. in the present work. Probably they were intended to form a part of a distinct treatise, and to have been ranged as propositions in that, but at present they are not so placed.


138 COLOURS.

there still remains a candle burning. Without such a trial the difference is hardly perceivable, particularly in those colours which have most si- milarity ; such as white and yellow, light green and light blue; because the light which strikes the blue, being yellow, will naturally turn it green ; as we have said in another place,* that a mixture of blue and yellow produces green. And if to a green colour you add some yellow, it will make it of a more beautiful green.

Chap. CCXLVI. — Of the Colouring of remote Objects.

The painter who is to represent objects at some distance from the eye, ought merely to convey the idea of general undetermined masses, making choice, for that purpose, of cloudy weather, or to- wards the evening, and avoiding, as was said be- fore, to mark the lights and shadows too strong on the extremities; because they would in that case appear like spots of difficult execution, and without grace. He ought to remember, that the shadows are never to be of such a quality, as to obliterate the proper colour, in which they origi- nated ; if the situation of the coloured body be not in total darkness. He ought to mark no outline, not to make the hair stringy, and not to touch with pure white, any but those things which in

  • See chap, ccxlviii.


COLOURS. 139

themselves are white ; in short, the hghtest touch upon any particular object ought to denote the beauty of its proper and natural colour.

Chap. CCXhYll.— The Surface of all opake Bo- dies participates of the Colour of the surrounding Objects.

The painter ought to know, that if any white object is placed between two walls, one of which is also white, and the other black, there will be found between the shady side of that object and the light side, a similar proportion to that of the two walls; and if that object be blue, the effect will be the same. Having therefore to paint this object, take some black, similar to that of the wall from which the reflexes come ; and to proceed by a certain and scientific method, do as follows. When you paint the wall, take a small spoon to measure exactly the quantity of colour you mean to employ in mixing your tints ; for instance, if you have put in the shading of this waU three spoonfuls of pure black, and one of white, you have, without any doubt, a mixture of a certain and precise quality. Now having painted one of the walls white, and the other dark, if you mean to place a blue object between them with shades suitable to that colour, place first on your pallet the light blue, such as you mean it to be, without any mixture of shade, and it will do for the lightest


140


COLOURS.


part of your object. After which take three spoon- fuls of black, and one of this light blue, for your darkest shades. Then observe whether your object be round or square : if it be square, these two ex- treme tints of light and shade will be close to each other, cutting sharply at the angle ; but if it be round, draw lines from the extremities of the walls to the centre of the object, and put the darkest shade between equal angles, where the lines inter- sect upon the superficies of it ; then begin to make them lighter and lighter gradually to the point N O, lessening the strength of the shadows as much as that place participates of the light A D, and mixing that colour with the darkest shade A B, in the same proportion.



COLOURS. 141

Chap. CCXLVIII. — General Remarks on Colours.

Blue and green are not simple colours in their nature, for blue is composed of light and dark- ness ; such is the azure of the sky, \Az. perfect black and perfect ^A'hite. Green is composed of a simple and a mixed colour, being produced by blue and yellow.

Any object seen in a mirror, wiU participate of the colour of that body which serves as a mirror ; and the mirror in its turn is tinged in part by the colour of the object it represents ; they partake more or less of each other as the colour of the object seen is more or less strong than the colour of the mirror. That object vAVi appear of the strongest and most liA'ely colour in the mirror, which has the most affinity to the colour of the mirror itself.

Of coloured bodies, the purest white will be seen at the greatest distance, therefore the darker the colour, the less it will bear distance.

Of different bodies equal in whiteness, and in distance from the eye, that which is surrounded by the greatest darkness wdU appear the whitest ; and on the contrary, that shadow will appear the darkest which has the brightest white round it.

Of different colours, equally perfect, that will appear most excellent, which is seen near its direct contrary. A pale colour against red, a black upon


142 COLOURS.

white (though neither the one nor the other are colours) ; blue near a yellow; green near red; be- cause each colour is more distinctly seen, when opposed to its contrary, than to any other similar to it.

Any thing white seen in a dense air full of va- pours, will appear larger than it is in reality.

The air, between the eye and the object seen, will change the colour of that object into its own; so will the azure of the air change the distant mountains into blue masses. Through a red glass every thing appears red ; the light round the stars is dimmed by the darkness of the air, which fills the space between the eye and the planets.

The true colour of any object whatever will be seen in those parts which are not occupied by any kind of shade, and have not any gloss (if it be a polished surface).

I say, that white terminating abruptly upon a dark ground, will cause that part where it termi- nates to appear darker, and the white whiter.


143


COLOURS IN REGARD TO LIGHT AND SHADOW.


Chap. CCXLIX. — Of the Lirjht proper for paint- ing Flesh Colour from Nature.

Your window must be open to the sky, and the walls painted of a reddish colour. The summer- time is the best, when the clouds conceal the sun, or else your walls on the south side of the room must be so high, as that the sun-beams cannot strike on the opposite side, in order that the reflexion of those beams may not destroy the shadows.

Chap. CCL. — Of the Painter's Window,

The window which gives light to a painting- room, ought to be made of oiled paper, without any cross bar, or projecting edge at the opening, or any sharp angle in the inside of the wall, but should be slanting by degrees the whole thickness of it; and the sides be painted black.

Chap. — CCLI. — llie Shadows of Colours. The shadows of any colour w hatever must par- ticipate of that colour more or less, as it is nearer


144 COLOURS IN REGARD TO

to, or more remote from, the mass of shadows ; and also in proportion to its distance from, or proximity to, the mass of hght.

Chap. CCLII.— 0/Me Shadows of White.

To any white body receiving the hght from the sun, or the air, the shadows should be of a blueish cast ; because white is no colour, but a receiver of all colours ; and as by the fourth proposition * we learn, that the surface of any object participates of the colours of other objects near it, it is evident that a white surface will participate of the colour of the air by which it is surrounded.

Chap. CCLIII. — Which of the Colours will pro- duce the darkest Shade.

That shade will be the darkest which is pro- duced by the whitest surface; this also will have a greater propensity to variety than any other sur- face ; because white is not properly a colour, but a receiver of colours, and its surface will partici- pate strongly of the colour of surrounding objects, but principally of black or any other dark colour, which being the most opposite to its nature, pro- duces the most sensible difference between the shadows and the Ughts.

  • See chap, cclxxiv.


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 145

Chap. CCLIV. — How to manage, ivhen a White terminates upon another White.

When one white body terminates on another of the same colour^ the white of these two bodies will be either alike or not. If they be alike, that object which of the two is nearest to the eye, should be made a little darker than the other, upon the round- ing of the outline; but if the object which serves as a ground to the other be not quite so white, the latter mil detach of itself, without the help of any darker termination.

Chap. CCLV. — On the Back-grounds of Figures.

Of two objects equally light, one will appear less so if seen upon a whiter ground ; and, on the con- trar}^, it wiU appear a great deal lighter if upon a space of a darker shade. So flesh colour will ap- pear pale upon a red ground, and a pale colour will appear redder upon a yellow ground. In short, colours will appear what they are not, according to the ground which surrounds them.

Chap. CCLVI. — The Mode of composing History.

Amongst the figures which compose an histo- rical picture, those which are meant to appear the nearest to the eye, must have the greatest force ; according to the second proposition* of the third

  • Although the author seems to have designed that this, and

many other propositions to which he refers, should have formed H


146 COLOURS IN REGARD TO

book, which says, that colour will be seen in the greatest perfection which has less air interposed 1)etween it and the eye of the beholder ; and for that reason the shadows (by which we express the relievo of bodies) apj^ear darker when near than when at a distance, being then deadened by the air which interposes. This does not happen to those shadows which are near the eye, where they will produce the greatest reUevo when they are darkest.

Chap. CCLVII. — Remarks concerning Lights and Shadows.

Observe, that where the shadows end, there be always a kind of half-shadow to blend them with the lights. The shadow derived from any object will mix more with the light at its termination, in proportion as it is more distant from that object. But the colour of the shadow will never be simple; this is proved by the ninth proposition,* which

a i)art of some regular work, and he has accordingly referred to them whenever he has mentioned them, by their intended nume- rical situation in that work, whatever it might be, it does not appear that he ever carried this design into execution. There are, however, several chapters in the present work, viz. ccxciii. cclxxxix. cclxxxv. coxcv. in which the principle in the text is recognised, and which propably would have been transferred into the projected treatise, if he had ever drawn it up.

  • The note on the preceding chapter is in a great measure appli-

cable to this, and the proposition mentioned in the text is also to be found in chapter ccxlvii. of the present work.


LIGHT AND SHADOW. 14/

says, that the superficies of any object participates of the colours of other bodies, by which it is sur- rounded, although it were transparent, such as water, air, and the like : because the air receives its light from the sun, and darkness is produced by the privation of it. But as the air has no co- lour in itself any more than water, it receives all the colours that are between the object and the eye. The vapours mixing wdth the air in the lower regions near the earth, render it thick, and apt to reflect the sun's rays on all sides, while the air above remains dark ; and because light (that is, white) and darkness (that is, black), mixed toge- ther, compose the azure that becomes the colour of the sky, which is lighter or darker in propor- tion as the air is more or less mixed with damp vapours.

Chap. CCLY1U.—Wh7j the Shadoivs of Bodies upon a vjhite Wall are blueish towards Evening.

The shadows of bodies produced by the redness of the setting sun, will always be bluish. This is accounted for by the eleventh proposition,* which says, that the superficies of any opake body parti- cipates of the colour of the object from which it receives the light j therefore the white wall being deprived entirely of colour, is tinged by the colour

• See the note on the chapter next but one preceding. The proposition in the text occurs in chap, ccxlvii. of the present work.

H 2


U8


COLOURS IN REGARD TO



m,^ ^iP


of those bodies from which it receives the Hght, which in this case are the sun and sky. But be- cause the sun is red towards the evening, and the- sky is blue, the shadow on the wall not being en- lightened by the sun, receives only the reflexion of the sky, and therefore wiU appear blue ; and the rest of the wall, receiving light immediately from the sun, will participate of its red colour.

Chap. CCIAX.—Ofthe Colour of Faces. Tlie colour of any object will appear more or less distinct in proportion to the extent of its surface. This proposition is proved, by observing that a face appears dark at a small distance, because, be- ing composed of many small parts, it produces a great number of shadoAvs; and the lights being the smallest part of it, are soonest lost to the sight, leaving only the shadows, which being in a greater


LIGHT AND SHADOW, 149

quantity, the whole of the face appears dark, and the more so if that face has on the head, or at the back, something whiter.

Chap. CCLX. — A Precept relating to Painting,

Where the shadows terminate upon the Hghts, observe well what parts of them are lighter than the others, and where they are more or less soft- ened and blended ; but above all remember, that young people have no sharp shadings : their flesh is transparent, something like what we obser\'e when we put our hand between the sun and eyes ; it appears reddish, and of a transparent bright- ness. If you wish to know what kind of shadow will suit the flesh colour you are painting, place one of your fingers close to your picture, so as to east a shadow upon it, and according as you wish it either lighter or darker, put it nearer or farther from it, and imitate it.

Chap. CCLXI. — Of Colours vn Shadow, It happens very often that the shadows of an opake body do not retain the same colour as the lights. Sometimes they will be greenish, while the lights are reddish, although this opake body be all over of one uniform colour. This happens when the light falls upon the object (we will sup- pose from the East), and tinges that side with its own colour. In the West we will suppose another


150 COLOURS IN REGARD TO

opake body of a colour different from the first, but receiving the same light. This last will reflect its colour towards the East, and strike the first with its rays on the opposite side, where they will be stopped, and remain with their full colour and brightness. We often see a white object with red lights, and the shades of a blueish cast ; this we observe particularly in mountains covered with snow, at sun-set, when the effulgence of its rays makes the horizon appear all on fire.

Chap. CCLXIL— 0//^e Choice of Lights.

Whatever object you intend to represent is to l)e supposed situated in a particular light, and that entirely of your own choosing. If you imagine such objects to be in the country, and the sun be overcast, they will be surrounded by a great quan- tity of general light. If the sun strikes upon those objects, then the shadows will be very dark, in proportion to the lights, and will be determined and sharp ; the primitive as well as the secondary ones. These shadows wiU vary from the lights in colour, because on that side the object receives a reflected light hue from the azure of the air, which tinges that part; and this is particularly observ- able in white objects. That side which receives the light from the sun, participates also of the colour of that. This may be particularly observed in the evening, when the sun is setting between


LIGHT AND SHADOW. -l5l

the clouds, which it reddens ; those clouds being tinged with the colour of the body illuminating them, the red colour of the clouds, with that of the sun, casts a hue on those parts which receive tlie light from them. On the contrary, those parts which are not turned towards that side of the sky, remain of the colour of the air, so that the former and the latter are of two different colours. This we must not lose sight of, that, knowing the cause of those hghts and shades, it be made apparent in the effect, or else the work will be false and absurd. But if a figure be situated within a house, and seen from without, such figure will have its sha- dows very soft ; and if the beholder stands in the hne of the hglit, it will acquire grace, and do credit to the painter, as it will have great relief in the lights, and soft and well-blended shadows, parti- cularly in those parts where the inside of the room appears less obscure, because there the shadows are almost imperceptible : the cause of which we shall explain in its proper place.


152 COIiOURS IN REGARD TO


COLOURS IN REGARD TO BACK- GROUNDS.


Chap. CCLXIII. — Of avoiding hard Outlines. Do not make the boundaries of your figures with any other colour than that of the back-ground on which they are placed; that is, avoid making dark outlines.

Chap. CCLXIV.— 0/ Outlines.

The extremities of objects which are at some distance, are not seen so distinctly as if they were nearer. Therefore the painter ought to regulate the strength of his outUnes, or extremities, accord- ing to the distance.

The boundaries which separate one body from another, are of the nature of mathematical lines, but not of real lines. Tlie end of any colour is only the beginning of another, and it ought not to be called a line, for nothing interposes between them, except the termination of the one against the other, which being nothing in itself, cannot be perceivable; therefore the painter ought not to pronounce it in distant objects.

Chap. CGLXN. —Of Back- grounds. One of the principal parts of painting is the


BACK-GROVNDS. 153

nature and quality of back-grounds, upon which the extremities of any convex or soHd body will always detach and be distinguished in nature, though the colour of such objects, and that of the ground, be exactly the same. This happens, be- cause the convex sides of solid bodies do not re- ceive the light in the same manner with the ground, for such sides or extremities are often lighter or darker than the ground. But if such extremities were to be of the same colour as the ground, and in the same degree of light, they cer- tainly could not be distinguished. Therefore. such a choice in painting ought to be avoided by all intelligent and judicious painters ; since the intention is to make the object appear as it were out of the ground. The above case would pro- duce the contrary effect, not only in painting, but also in objects of real relievo.

Chap. CCLXVI. — Hotv to detach Figures from the Ground.

All solid bodies will appear to have a greater relief, and to come more out of the canvass, on a ground of an undetermined colour, with the great- est variety of lights and shades against the con- fines of such bodies (as will be demonstrated in its place), provided a proper diminution of lights in the white tints, and of darkness in the shades, be judiciously observed.

H 5


154 BACK-GROUNDS,

Chap. CCLXVII. — Of Uniformity and Variety of Colours ujjon plain Surfaces.

The back-grounds of any flat surfaces which are uniform in colour and quantity of light, will never appear separated from each other; vice versa, they will appear separated if they are of different colours or lights.

Chap. CCLXVIII. — Of Back-grounds suitabk both to Shadows and Lights. The shadows or lights which surround figures, or any other objects, will help the more to detach them the more they differ from the objects ; that is, if a dark colour does not terminate upon an- other dark colour, but upon a very different one ; as white, or partaking of white, but lowered, and approximated to the dark shade.

Chap. CCLXIX. — The apparent Variation of Colours, occasioned by the Contraste of the Ground upon which they are placed.

No colour appears uniform and equal in all its parts, unless it terminate on a ground of the same colour. This is very apparent when a black ter- minates on a white ground, where the contraste of colour gives more strength and richness to the extremities than to the middle.


'CONTRASTE, HARMONY^ AND REFLEXES. I').')


CONTRASTS, HARMONY, AND REFLEX- ES, IN REGARD TO COLOURS.


Chap. CCLXX. — Gradation in Painting.

"What is fine is not always ijeautiful and good: I address this to such painters as are so attached to the beauty of colours, that they regret being obhged to give them almost imperceptible sha- dows, not considering the beautiful relief which figures acquire by a proper gradation and strength of shadows. Such persons may be compared to those speakers who in conversation make use of many fine words without meaning, which altoge- ther scarcely form one good sentence.

Chap. CCLXXL — How to assort Colours in such a Manner as that they may add Beauty to each other.

If you mean that the proximity of one colour shoxdd give beauty to another that terminates near it, observe tlse rays of the sun in the compo- sition of the rainbow, the colours of which are generated by the falling rain, when each drop in its descent takes every colour of tliat bow, as is demonstrated in its place*.

  • Not in thiff work.


156 CONTRASTE, HARMONY, AND REFLEXES.

If you mean to represent great darkness, it must be done by contrasting it with great light ; on the contrary, if you want to produce great brightness, you must oppose to it a very dark shade : so a pale yellow will cause red to appear more beautiful than if opposed to a purple colour.

There is another rule, by observing which, though you do not increase the natural beauty of the colours, yet by bringing them together they may give additional grace to each other, as green placed near red, while the effect would be quite the reverse, if placed near blue.

Harmony and grace are also produced by a ju- dicious arrangement of colours, such as blue with pale yellow or white, and the like ; as will be no- ticed in its place.

Chap. CCLXXII. — Of detaching the Figures.

Let the colours of which the draperies of your figures are composed, be such as to form a pleas- ing variety, to distinguish one from the other; and although, for the sake of harmony, they should be of the same nature*, they must not stick toge-


  • I do aot know a better comment on this passage than Feli-

bien's Examination of Le Brim's Picture of the Tent of Darius. From this (which has been reprinted with an English translation by Colonel Parsons, in 1700, in folio,) it wiU clearly appear, what the chain of connexion is between every colour there used, and its nearest neighbour, and consequently a rule may be formed from it


CONTRASTE, HARMONY, AND REFLEXES. 157

tlier, but vary in point of light, according to the distance and interposition of the air between them. By the same rule, the outhnes are to be more precise, or lost, in proportion to their dis- tance or proximity.

Chap. CCLXXIII.— 0/ the Colour of Reflexes.

All reflected colours are less brilliant and strong, than those which receive a direct light, in the same proportion as there is between the light of a body and the cause of that light.

Chap. CCL,XX\\ .—What Body will be the most strongly tinged trith the Colour of any other Object.

An opake surface will partake most of the ge- nuine colour of the body nearest to it, because a great quantity of the species of colour will be con- veyed to it; whereas such colour would be broken and disturbed if coming from a more distant ob- ject.

Chap. CCLXXV.— 0//?e/e.z'e*.

Reflexes will partake, more or less, both of the colour of the object which produces them, and of the colour of that object on Avhich they are

with more certainty and precision than where the student is left to develope it for himself, from the mere infection of different examples of colouring.


158 CONTRASTE, HARMONY, AND REFLEXES.

produced, in proportion as this latter body is of a smoother or more polished surface, than that by which they are produced.

Chap. CCLXXVL— 0/ the Surface of all sha- dowed Bodies.

The surface of any opake body placed in sha- dow, will participate of the colour of any other object which reflects the light upon it. This is very evident ; for if such bodies were deprived of light in the space between them and the other bodies, they could not shew either shape or co- lour. We shall conclude then, that if the opake body be yellow, and that which reflects the light blue, the part reflected will be green, because green is composed of blue and yellow.

Chaf. CCLXXVIL— 77m/ no reflected Colour is simple, but is mixed with the nature of the other Coloiirs.

No colour reflected upon the surface of an- other body, will tinge that surface with its own colour alone, but will be mixed by the concurrence of other colours also reflected on the same spot. Let us suppose A to be of a yellow colour, which is reflected on the convex C O E, and that the blue colour B be reflected on the same place. I say that a mixture of the blue and yellow colours will tinge the convex surface ; and that, if the


CONTRASTE, HARMONY, AND REFLEXES. 159



ground be white, it will produce a green reflexion, because it is proved that a mixture of blue and yellow produces a very fine green.

Chap. CCLXXVIIL— 0/ the Colour of Lights and Reflexes.

When two lights strike upon an opake body, they can vary only in two ways ; either they are equal in strength, or they are not. If they be equal, they may still vary in two other ways, that is, by the equality or inequality of their brightness; they will be equal, if their distance be the same ; and unequal, if it be otherwise. The object placed at an equal distance, between two equal lights, in point both of colour and brightness, may still be enlightened by them in two different ways, either equally on each side, or unequally. It will be equally enhghtened by them, when the space which


160 CONTRASTE, HARMONY, AND REFLEXES.

remains round the lights shall be equal in colour, in degree of shade, and in brightness. It will be unequally enhghtened by them Avhen the spaces happen to be of different degrees of darkness.

Chap. CCLXXIX. — Why reflected Colours seldom partake of the Colour of the Body where they meet.

It happens very seldom that the reflexes are of the same colour with the body from which they proceed, or with that upon which they meet. To exemplify this, let the convex body D F G E be of a yellow colour, and the body B C, which re- flects its colour on it, blue ; the part of the convex surface which is struck by that reflected light, will take a green tinge, being B C, acted on by the natural light of the air or the sun.



CONTRASTE, HARMONY, AND REFLEXES. 161

Chap. CCLXXX.— 7%e Reflexes of Flesh Colours.

The lights upon the flesh colours, which are re- flected by the hght strikuig upon another flesh- coloured body, are redder and more hvely than any other part of the human figure ; and that hap- pens according to the third proposition of the second book,* which says, the surface of any opake body participates of the colour of the object which reflects the light in proportion as it is near to or remote from it, and also in proportion to the size of it ; because, being large, it prevents the variety of colours in smaller objects round it, from in- terfering with, and discomposing the principal colour, which is nearer. Nevertheless it does not prevent its participating more of the colour of a small object near it, than of a large one more re- mote. See the sixth proposition f of perspective, which says, that large objects may be situated at such a distance as to appear less than smaU ones that are near.


  • See chap, ccxxiii. ccxxx\ai. ccbcxiv. cclxxxii. of the present

work. We have before remarked, that the propositions so fre- quently referred to by the author, were never reduced into form, though apparently he intended a regular work in which they were to be included.

t No where in this work.


162 CONTBASTEj HARMONY, AND REFLEXES.

CiiAP. CCLXXXL— 0/ the Nature of Compa- rison. Black draperies will make the flesh of the human figure appear whiter than in reality it is ; * and white draperies, on the contrary, will make it appear darker. Yellow will render it higher co- loured, while red will make it pale.

Chap. CCLXXXII. — TVhere theReflexes are seen.

Of all reflexions of the same shape, size, and strength, that will be more or less strong, w^hich terminates on a ground more or less dark.

The surface of those bodies will partake most of the colour of the object that reflects it, which re- ceive that reflexion by the most nearly equal angles.

Of the colours of objects reflected upon any opposite surface by equal angles, that will be the most distinct which has its reflecting ray the shortest.

Of all colours, reflected under equal angles, and at equal distance upon the opposite body, those will be the strongest, which come reflected by the lightest coloured body.

That object will reflect its owm colour most pre- cisely on the opposite object, which has not round

  • This is evident in many of Vandyke's portraits, particularly

of ladies, many of wliom are dressed in black velvet ; and this re- mark will in some measure account for the delicate fairness which he frequently gives to the female complexion.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 163

it any colour that clashes with its own ; and con- sequently that reflected colour will be most con- fused which takes its origin from a variety of bo- dies of different colours.

That colour which is nearest the opposed object, will tinge it the most strongly ; and vice versd : let the painter, therefore, in his reflexes on the human body, particularly on the flesh colour, mix some of the colour of the drapery which comes nearest to it ; but not pronounce it too distinctly, if there be not good reason for it.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.


Chap. CCLXXXIIL— ^ Precept of Perspective in regard to Pumting. When, on account of some particular quality of the air, you can no longer distinguish the diflfe- rence between the lights and shadows of objects, you may reject the perspective of shadows, and make use only of the linear perspective, and the diminution of colours, to lessen the knowledge of the objects opposed to the eye ; and this, that is to say, the loss of the knowledge of the figure of each object, will make the same object appear more remote.


164 PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

The eye can never arrive at a perfect knowledge of the interval between two objects variously dis- tant, by means of the linear perspective alone, if not assisted by the perspective of colours.

Chap. CCLXXXIV.— 0/ the Perspective of Colours.

The air will participate less of the azure of the sky, in proportion as it comes nearer to the hori- zon, as it is proved by the third and ninth propo- sition,* that pure and subtile bodies (such as com- pose the air) will be less illuminated by the sun than those of thicker and grosser substance : and as it is certain that the air which is remote from the earth, is thinner than that which is near it, it will foUow, that the latter will be more impreg- nated with the rays of the sun, which giving light at the same time to an infinity of atoms floating in this air, renders it more sensible to the eye. So that the air will appear lighter towards the horizon^ and darker as weU as bluer in looking up to the sky ; because there is more of the thick air between our eyes and the horizon, than between our eyes and that part of the sky above our heads.


• These propositions, any more than the others mentioned in different parts of this work, were never digested into a regular treatise, as was evidently intended by the author, and consequently are not to be found, except perhaps in some of the volumes of the author's manuscript collections.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 165



For instance : if the eye placed in P, looks through the air along the line P R, and then lowers itself a little along P S, the air will begin to ap- pear a little whiter, because there is more of the thick air in this space than in the first. And if it be still removed lower, so as to look straight at the horizon, no more of that blue sky will be per- ceived which was observable along the first line P R, because there is a much greater quantity of thick air along the horizontal line P D, than along the obhque P S, or the perpendicular P R.

Chap. CCLXXXV. — The Cause of the Diminu- tion of Colours.

The natural colour of any visible object will be diminished in proportion to the density of any


166 PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

other substance which interposes between that object and the eye.

Chap. CCLXXXVI.— 0/ the Diminution of Co- lours and Objects.

Let the colours vanish in proportion as the objects diminish in size, according to the distance.

Chap. CCLXXXVIL— 0/Me Variety observable in Colours, according to their distance or proxi- mity.

The local colour of such objects as are darker than the air, will appear less dark as they are more remote; and, on the contrary, objects lighter than the air will lose their brightness in proportion to their distance from the eye. In general, all ob- jects that are darker or lighter than the air, are discoloured by distance, which changes their qua- lity, so that the lighter appears darker, and the darker lighter.

Chap. CCLXXXVIII. — J/ what Distance Co- lours are entirely lost.

Local colours are entirely lost at a greater or less distance, according as the ej-e and the object are more or less elevated from the earth. This is proved by the seventh proposition*, which says

  • See chap, ccxciii. cccvii. cccviii.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 167

the air is more or less pure, as it is near to, or remote from the earth. If the eye, then, and the object are near the earth, the thickness of the air which interposes, will in a great measure confuse the colour of that object to the eye. But if the eye and the object are placed high above the earth, the air will disturb the natural colour of that object very little. In short, the various gra- dations of colour depend not only on the various distances, in which they may be lost ; but also on the variety of lights, which change according to the different hours of the day, and the thickness or purity of the air, through which the colour of the object is conveyed to the eye.

Chap. CCLXXXIX.— 0/Me Change observable in the same Colour, according to its Distance from the Eye.

Among several colours of the same nature, that which is the nearest to the eye wall alter the least ; because the air which interposes between the eye and the object seen, envelopes, in some measure, that object. If the air, which interposes, be in great quantity, the object seen will be strongly tinged with the colour of that air ; but if the air be thin, then the ^dew of that ol:)ject, and its colour, mil be very little obstructed.


168 PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

Chap. CCXC. — Of the blueish Appearance of re- mote Objects in a Landscape.

Whatever be the colour of distant objects, the darkest, whether natural or accidental, will appear the most tinged with azure. By the na- tural darkness is meant the proper colour of the object; the accidental one is produced by the shadow of some other body.

Chap. CCXCI. — Of the Qualities in the Surface which first lose themselves by Distance.

The first part of any colour which is lost by the distance, is the gloss, being the smallest part of it, as a light within a light. The second that diminishes by being farther removed, is the light, because it is less in quantity than the shadow. The third is the principal shadows, nothing re- maining at last but a kind of middling obscurity.

Chap. CCXCII. — From what cause the azure of the Air proceeds.

The azure of the sky is produced by the trans- parent body of the air, illumined by the sun, and interposed between the darkness of the expanse above, and the earth below. The air in itself has no quahty of smell, taste, or colour, but is easily impregnated with the quality of other matter sur- rounding it ; and will appear bluer in proportion


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 169

to the darkness of the space behind it, as may be obsen-ed against the shady sides of mountains, which are darker than any other object. In this instance the air appears of the most beautiful azure, while on the other side that receives the light, it shews through that more of the natural colour of the mountain.

Chap. CCXCIIL— 0/ the Perspective of Colours.

The same colour being placed at various dis- tances and equal elevation, the force and effect of its colouring will be according to the proportion of the distance which there is from each of these colours to the eye. It is proved thus : let A B E D be one and the same colour. The first, E, is placed at two degrees of distance from the eye A; the second, B, shall be four degrees; the third, C, six degrees ; and the fourth, D, eight de- grees ; as appears by the circles which terminate upon and intersect the line A R. Let us suppose that the space A R, S P, is one degree of thin air, and S P E T another degree of thicker air. It will follow, that the first colour, E, will pass to the eye through one degree of thick air, E S, and through another degree, S A, of thinner air. And B will send its colour to the eye in A, through two degrees of thick air, and through two others of the thinner sort. C wiU send it through three degrees of the thin, and three of the thick sort,


170


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.


while D goes through four degrees of the one, and four of the other. This demonstrates, that the gradation of colours is in proportion to their dis- tance from the eye*. But this happens only to those colours which are on a level with the eye ; as for those which happen to be at unequal eleva- tions, we cannot obserA^e the same rule, because they are in that case situated in different quaUties of air, which alter and diminish these colours in various manners.


2 3 4-56 7 8



Chap. CCXCIV.— 0/ the Perspective of Colours in dark Places.

In any place where the light diminishes in a gradual proportion, till it terminates in total dark- ness, the colours also will lose themselves and be dissolved in proportion as thej recede from the eye.


  • See chap, cclzxxvii.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 171

Chap. CCXCY.— Of the Perspective of Colours.

The princii^al colours, or those nearest to the eye, should be pure and simple; and the degree of their diminution should be in proportion to their distance, viz. the nearer they are to the principal point, the more they will possess of the purity of those colours, and they will partake of the colour of the horizon in proportion as they approach to it.

Chap. CCXCVL— 0/ Colours.

Of all the colours which are not blue, those that are nearest to black will, when distant, partake most of the azure; and, on the contrary, those will preserve their proper colour at the greatest dis- tance, that are most dissimilar to black.

The green therefore of the fields will change sooner into blue than yellow, or white, which will preserve their natural colour at a greater distance than that, or even red.

Chap. CCXCVII. — IIoiv it happens that Colours do not change, though placed in different Quali- ties of Air.

The colour will not be subject to any alteration when the distance and the quality of air have a re- ciprocal proportion. ,AVhat it loses by the distance it regains by the purity of the air, viz. if we sup- pose the first or lowest air to have four degrees of i2


172 PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

thickness, and the colour to be at one degree from the eye, and the second air above to have three degrees. The air having lost one degree of thick- ness, the colour will acquire one degree upon the distance. And when the air still higher shall have lost two degrees of thickness, the colour will ac- quire as many upon the distance ; and in that case the colour m^U be the same at three degrees as at one. But to be brief, if the colour be raised so high as to enter that quahty of air which has lost three degrees of thickness, and acquired three de- grees of distance, then you may be certain that that colour which is high and remote, has lost no more than the colour which is below and nearer ; because in rising it has acquired those three de- grees which it was losing by the same distance from the eye ; and this is what was meant to be proved.

Chap. CXCVIII. — Why Colours experience no apparent Change, though placed in different Qualities of Air.

It may happen that a colour does not alter, though placed at different distances, when the thickness of the air and the distance are in the same inverse proportion. It is proved thus : — let A be the eye, and H any colour whatever, placed at one degree of distance from the eye, in a qua- lity of air of four degrees of thickness ; but be-


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.


17s


Air of one degree of -£^ s density.



Two degrees of ditto.


Three degrees of ditto.


3 degrees of distance.


cause the second degree above, A M N L, con- tains a thinner air by one-half, which air conveys this colour, it foUows that this colour will appear as if removed double the distance it was at before, viz. at two degrees of distance, A F and F G, from the eye ; and it wiU be placed in G. If that is raised to the second degree of air A M N L, and to the degree O M, P N, it will necessarily be placed at E, and will be removed from the eye the whole length of the line A E, w^hich will be proved in this manner to be equal in thickness to the distance A G. If in the same quality of air the distance A G interposed between the eye and the colour occupies two degrees, and A E occu- pies two degrees and a half, it is sufficient to pre- serve the colour G, when raised to E, from any change, because the degree A C and the degree A F being the same in thickness, are equal and alike, and the degree C D, though equal in length


174 PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

to the degree F G, is not alike in point of thick- ness of air ; because half of it is situated in a de- gree of air of double the thickness of the air above : this half degree of distance occupies as much of the colour as one whole degree of the air above would, which air above is twice as thin as the air below, with which it terminates ; so that by calculating the thickness of the air, and the distances, you vnll find that the colours have changed places without undergoing any alteration in their beauty. And we shall prove it thus : reckoning first the thickness of the air, the colour H is placed in four degrees of thickness, the co- lour G in two degrees, and E at one degree. Now let us see whether the distances are in an equal inverse proportion ; the colour E is at two degrees and a half of distance, G at two degrees, and H at one degree. But as this distance has not an exact proportion with the thickness of the air, it is ne- cessary to make a third calculation in this man- ner : A C is perfectly like and equal to A F ; the half degree, C B, is like but not equal to A F, be- cause it is only half a degree in length, which is equal to a whole degree of the quahty of the air above ; so that by this calculation we shall solve the question. For A C is equal to two degrees of thickness of the air above, and the half degree C B is equal to a whole degree of the same air above; and one degree more is to be taken in,


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 175

viz. B E, which makes the fourth. A H has four degrees of thickness of air, A G also four, viz. A F two in value, and F G also two, which taken together make four. A E has also four, because A C contains two, and C D one, which is the half of A C, and in the same quality of air ; and there is a whole degree above in the thin air, which alto- gether make four. So that if A E is not double the distance A G, nor four times the distance A H, it is made equivalent by the half degree C E of thick air, which is equal to a whole degree of thin air above. This proves the truth of the proposi- tion, that the colour H G E does not undergo any alteration by these different distances.

Chap. CCXCIX. — Contrary Opinions in regard to Objects seen afar off.

Many painters will represent the objects darker, in proportion as they are removed from the eye ; but this cannot be true, unless the objects seen be white; as shall be examined in the next chapter.

Chap. CCC. — Of the Colour of Objects remote from the Eye.

The air tinges objects with its otvti colour more or less in proportion to the quantity of interven- ing air between it and the eye, so that a dark object at the distance of two miles (or a density of


176 PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

air equal to such distance), will be more tinged with its colour than if only one mile distant.

It is said, that, in a landscape, trees of the same species appear darker in the distance than near; this cannot be true, if they be of equal size, and divided by equal spaces. But it wiU be so if the first trees are scattered, and the light of the fields is seen through and between them, while the others which are farther off, are thick together, as is often the case near some river or other jaiece of water : in this case no space of light fields can be per- ceived, but the trees appear thick together, accu- mulating the shadow on each other. It also hap- pens, that as the shady parts of plants are much broader than the light ones, the colour of the plants becoming darker by the multiplied shadows, is preserved, and conveyed to the eye more strongly than that of the other parts ; these masses, there- fore, will carry the strongest parts of their colour to a greater distance.

Chap. CCCI. — Of the Colour of Mountains.

The darker the mountain is in itself, the bluer it will appear at a great distance. The highest part will be the darkest, as being more woody ; because woods cover a great many shrubs, and other plants, which never receive any light. The wild plants of those woods are also naturally of a darker hue than cultivated plants ; for oak, beech.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 177

fir, cypress, and pine trees are much darker than olive and other domestic plants. Near the top of these mountains, where the air is thinner and purer, the darkness of the woods will make it appear of a deeper azure, than at the bottom, where the air is thicker. A plant will detach very little from the ground it stands upon, if that ground be of a colour something similar to its own ; and, vice versa, that part of any white object which is nearest to a dark one, will appear the whitest, and the less so as it is removed from it j and any dark object wiU appear darker, the nearer it is to a white one; and less so, if removed from it.

Chap. CCCII. — W7iy the Colour and Shape of Objects are lost in some Situations apparently dark, though not so in Reality.

There are some situations which, though light, appear dark, and in which objects are deprived both of form and colour. This is caused by the great light which pervades the intervening air ; as is observable by looking in through a window at some distance from the eye, when nothing is seen but an uniform darkish shade ; but if we enter the house, we shall find that room to be fuU of light, and soon distinguish every small object contained within that window. This difference of effect is produced by the great brightness of the air, which I 5


178 PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

contracts considerably the pupil of the eye, and by so doing diminishes its power. But in dark places the pupil is enlarged, and acquires as much in strength, as it increases in size. This is proved in my second proposition of perspective.*

Chap. CCCIII. — Various Precepts in Painting,

The termination and shape of the parts in gene- ral are very little seen, either in great masses of light, or of shadows ; but those which are situated between the extremes of light and shade are the most distinct.

Perspective, as far as it extends in regard to painting, is divided into three principal parts ; the first consists in the diminution of size according to distance; the second concerns the diminution of colours in such objects ; and the third treats of the diminution of the perception altogether of those objects, and of the degree of precision they ought to exhibit at various distances.

The azure of the sky is produced by a mixture composed of light and darknessjf I say of hght, because of the moist particles floating in the air, which reflect the light. By darkness, I mean the pure air, which has none of these extraneous par- ticles to stop and reflect the rays. Of this we see an example in the air interposed between the eye

  • This book on perspective was never drawn up.

•f See chap, ccxcii.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS. 179

and some dark mountains, rendered so by the shadows of an innumerable quantity of trees ; or else shaded on one side by the natural privation of the rays of the sun; this air becomes azure, but not so on the side of the mountain which is light, particularly when it is covered \\'ith snow.

Among objects of equal darkness and equal distance, those will appear darker that terminate upon a lighter ground, and vice versd*

That object which is painted with the most white and the most black, will shew greater rehef than any other ; for that reason I would recom- mend to painters to colour and dress their figures with the brightest and most lively colours ; for if they are painted of a dull or obscure colour, they will detach but Httle, and not be much seen, when the picture is placed at some distance ; because the colour of every object is obscured in the shades ; and if it be represented as originally so all over, there will be but little difference between the lights and the shades, M-hile lively colours will shew a striking difference.

  • See chap, ccxii. ccxlviii. cclv.


80 AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.


Chap. CCCIV. — Aerial Perspective.

There is another kind of perspective called aerial, because by the difference of the air it is easy to determine the distance of different objects, though seen on the same line ; such, for instance, as buildings behind a wall, and appearing all of the same height above it. If in your picture you want to have one appear more distant than another, you must first suppose the air somewhat thick, because, as we have said before, in such a kind of air the objects seen at a great distance, as moun- tains are, appear blueish hke the air, by means of the great quantity of air that interposes between the eye and such mountains. You will then paint the first building behind that wall of its proper colour ; the next in point of distance, less distinct in the outline, and participating, in a greater degree, of the blueish colour of the air ; another, which you wish to send off as much farther, should be painted as much bluer ; and if you wish one of them to appear five times farther removed beyond the wall, it must have five times more of the azure.


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE. 181

By this rule these buildings which appeared all of the same size, and upon the same line, will be distinctly perceived to be of different dimensions, and at different distances.

Chap. CCCV. — The Parts of the smallest Objects will first disappear in Painting.

Of objects receding from the eye the smallest will be first lost to the sight; from which it fol- lows, that the largest will be the last to disappear. The painter, therefore, ought not to finish the parts of those objects which are very far oif, but follow the rule given in the sixth book.*

How many, in the representation of towns, and other objects remote from the eye, express every part of the buildings in the same manner as if they were very near. It is not so in nature, because there is no sight so powerful as to perceive dis- tinctly at any great distance the precise form of parts or extremities of objects. The painter there- fore who pronounces the outlines, and the minute distinction of parts, as several have done, will not give the representation of distant objects, but by this error will make them appear exceedingly near. Again, the angles of buildings in distant towns are not to be expressed (for they cannot be seen),

  • There is no work of tliis author to which this can at prescut

refer, but the principle is laid clown in chapters cclxxiv. cccvi. of the present treatise.


182 AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.

considering that angles are formed by the concur- rence of two lines into one point, and that a point ' has no parts; it is therefore invisible.

Chap. CCCVI. — Small Figures ought not to be too much finished.

Objects appear smaller than they really are when they are distant from the eye, and because there is a great deal of air interposed, which weakens the appearance of forms, and, by a natural conse- quence, prevents our seeing distinctly the minute parts of such objects. It behoves the painter therefore to touch those parts slightly, in an unfi- nished manner ; otherwise it would be against the effect of Nature, whom he has chosen for his guide. For, as we said before, objects appear small on account of their great distance from the eye ; that distance includes a great quantity of air, which, forming a dense body, obstructs the light, and prevents our seeing the minute parts of the objects.

Chap. CCCVII. — Why the Air is to appear whiter as it approaches nearer to the Karth.

As the air is thicker nearer the earth, and be- comes thinner as it rises, look, when the sun is in the east, towards the west, betw^een the north and south, and you will perceive that the thickest and lowest air will receive more light from the sun


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE. 183

than the thinner air, because its beams meet with more resistance.

If the sky terminate low, at the end of a plain, that part of it nearest to the horizon, being seen only through the thick air, will alter and break its natural colour, and will appear whiter than over your head, where the Ansual ray does not pass through so much of that gross air, corrupted by earthy A^apours. But if you turn towards the east, the air will be darker the nearer it approaches the earth ; for the air being thicker, does not admit the light of the sun to pass so freely.

Chap. CCCVIII. — How to paint the distant Part of a Landscape.

It is evident that the air is in some parts thicker and grosser than in others, particularly that nearest to the earth; and as it rises higher, it becomes thinner and more transparent. The objects which are high and large, from which you are at some distance, will be less apparent in the lower parts ; because the visual ray which perceives them, passes through a long space of dense air; and it is easy to prove that the upper parts are seen by a line, which, though on the side of the eye it originates in a thick air, nevertheless, as it ascends to the highest summit of its object, terminates in an air much thinner than that of the lower parts ; and for that reason the more that line or visual ray


184 AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.

advances from the eye, it becomes, in its progress from one point to another, thinner and thinner, passing from a pure air into another which is purer ; so that a painter who has mountains to re- present in a landscape, ought to observe, that from one hill to another, the tops will appear always clearer than the bases. In proportion as the dis- stance from one to another is greater, the top will be clearer ; and the higher they are, the more they will show their variety of form and colour.

Chap. CCCIX. — Of precise and confused Objects.

The parts that are near in the fore-ground should be finished in a bold determined manner ; but those in the distance must be unfinished, and confused in their outlines.

Chap. CCCX.— Of distant Objects.

That part of any object which is nearest to the luminary from which it receives the light, Mali be the lightest.

The representation of an object in every degree of distance, loses degrees of its strength ; that is, in proportion as the object is more remote from the eye it will be less perceivable through the air in its representation.

Chai\ CCCXI: — Of Buildings seen in a thick Air. That part of a building seen through a thick air.


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE. 185

will appear less distinct than another part seen through a thinner air. Therefore the eye, N,

A r^WX]

- :::;-vv-N



looking at the tower A D, will see it more con- fusedly in the lower degrees, but at the same time lighter; and as it ascends to the other de- grees it AviU appear more distinct, but somewhat darker.

Chap. CCCXIL— 0/* Toums and other Objects seen through a thick Air.

Buildings or towns seen through a fog, or the air made thick by smoke or other vapours, will appear less distinct the lower they are ; and, vice versa, they wdU be sharper and more visible in proportion as they are higher. We have said in chapter cccxxi. that the air is thicker the lower it is, and thinner as it is higher. It is demon- strated also by the cut, where the tower, A F, is


186 AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.

seen by the eye N, in a thick air, from B to F,

^g-^cmr^/^


which is divided into four degrees, growing thicker as they are nearer the bottom. The less the quan- tity of air interposed between the eye and its object is, the less also will the colour of the object parti- cipate of the colour of that air. It follows, that the greater the quantity of air interposed between the eye and the object seen, is, the more this ob- ject will ^participate of the colour of the air. It is demonstrated thus : N being the eye looking at the five parts of the tower A F, viz. A B C D E, I say, that if the air were of the same thickness, there would be the same proportion between the colour of the air at the bottom of the tower and the colour of the air that the same tower has at the place B, as there is in length between the line M and F. As, however, we have supposed that the air is not of equal thickness, but, on the con- trary, thicker as it is lower, it follows, that the


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE. 187

proportion by which the air tinges the different elevations of the tower B C F, exceeds the propor- tion of the hnes ; because the Une M F, besides its being longer than the Hne S B, passes by un- equal degrees through a quality of air which is unequal in thickness.

Chap. CCCXIII. — Of the inferior Extremities of distant Objects.

Tlie inferior or lower extremities of distant ob- jects are not so apparent as the upper extremities. This is observable in mountains and hills, the tops of which detach from the sides of other mountains behind. We see the tops of these more deter- mined and distinctly than their bases ; because the upper extremities are darker, being less encom- passed by thick air, which always remains in the lower regions, and makes them appear dim and confused. It is the same with trees, buildings, and other objects high up. From this effect it often happens that a high tower, seen at a great distance, will appear broad at top, and narrow at bottom ; because the thin air towards the top does not prevent the angles on the sides and other dif- ferent parts of the tower from being seen, as the thick air docs at bottom. This is demonstrated by the seventh proposition,* which says, that the thick air interposed between the eye and the sun, • See chapters cccvii. cccxxii.


188 AERIAL. PERSPECTIVE.

is lighter below than above, and where the air is whiteish, it confuses the dark objects more than if such air were blueish or thinner, as it is higher up. The battlements of a fortress have the spaces between equal to the breadth of the battlement, and yet the space will appear wider ; at a great distance the battlements will appear very much diminished, and being removed still farther, will disappear entirely, and the fort show only the straight wall, as if there were no battlements.

Chap. CCCXIY .—Which Parts of Objects disap- pear first by being removed farther from the Eye, and which preserve their Appearance.

The smallest parts are those which, by being removed, lose their appearance first ; this may be observed in the gloss upon spherical bodies, or columns, and the slender parts of animals ; as in a stag, the first sight of which does not discover its legs and horns so soon as its body, which, be- ing broader, will be perceived from a greater dis- tance. But the parts which disappear the very first, are the Unes which describe the members, and terminate the surface and shape of bodies.

CiiAP. CCCXV. — Why Objects are less distin- guished in proportion as they are fart her removed from the Eye. This happens because the smallest parts are lost


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE. 189

first ; the second, in point of size, are also lost at a somewhat greater distance, and so on succes- sively; the parts by degrees melting away, the perception of the object is diminished ; and at last all the parts, and the whole, are entirely lost to the sight.* Colours also disappear on account of the density of the air interposed between the eye and the object.

Chap. CCCXVI. — IVhy Faces appear dark at a distance.

It is evident that the similitude of all objects placed before us, large as well as small, is percepti- ble to our senses through the iris of the eye. If through so small an entrance the immensity of the sky and of the earth is admitted, the faces of men (which are scarcely any thing in comparison of such large objects), being still diminished by the dis- tance, will occupy so little of the eye, that they become almost imperceptible. Besides, having to pass through a dark medium from the surface to the Retina in the inside, where the impression is made, the colour of faces, (not being very strong, and rendered still more obscure by the darkness of the tube) when arrived at the focus appears dark. No other reason can be given on that point, except that the speck in the middle of the apple i»f the eye is black, and, being full of a transpa-

• See chap. civi. cxxi. cccv.


190 AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.

rent fluid like air, performs the same office as a hole in a board, which on looking into it appears black; and that those things which are seen through both a light and dark air, become con- fused and obscure.

Chap. CCCXVIL— 0/ Towns and other Buildings seen through a Fog in the Morning or Evening.

Buildings seen afar off in the morning or in the evening, when there is a fog, or thick air, show only those parts distinctly which are enlightened by the sun towards the horizon ; and the parts of those buildings which are not turned towards the sun remain confused and almost of the colour of the fog.

Chap. CCCXVIII.— 0/ the Height of Buildings seen in a Fog.

Of a building near the eye the top parts will appear more confused than the bottom ; because there is more fog between the eye and the top than at the base. And a square tower, seen at a great distance through a fog, will appear narrower at the base than at the summit. This is accounted for in chapter cccxiii. which says, that the fog will appear whiter and thicker as it approaches the ground; and, as it is said before,* that a dark object will appear smaller in proportion as it is

  • See chap, cccxiii. and cccxxiii.


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.


191


placed on a whiter ground. Therefore the fog being whiter at bottom than at top, it follows that the tower (being darkish) will appear narrower at the base than at the summit.


Chap. CCCXIX. — Jlliy Objects which are high, appear darker at a Distance than those which are loiv, though the Fog be uniform, and of equal Thickness.

Amongst objects situated in a fog, thick air, vapour, smoke, or at a distance, the highest will be the most distinctly seen : and amongst objects equal in height, that placed in the darkest fog, wall be most confused and dark. As it happens to the eye H, looking at A B C, three towers of equal

H

B ■:::-■-■■ c"" /



height ; it sees the top C as low as R, in two de- grees of thickness ; and the top B, in one degree only ; therefore the top C will appear darker than the top of the tower B.


192 AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.

Chap. CCCXX.— 0/ Objects seen in a Foy.

Objects seen through a fog will appear larger than they are in reality, because the aerial perspec- tive does not agree with the linear, viz. the colour does not agree with the magnitude of the object;* such a fog being similar to the thickness of air in- terposed between the eye and the horizon in fine weather. But in this case the fog is near the eye, and though the object be also near, it makes it appear as if it were as far off as the horizon ; where a great tower would appear no bigger than a man placed near the eye.

  • To our obtaining a correct idea of tbe magnitude and distance

of any object seen from afar, it is necessary that we consider how much of distinctness an object loses at a distance (from the mere interposition of the air) , as well as what it loses in size ; and these two considerations must unite before we can decidedly pronounce as to its distance or magnitude. This calculation, as to distinct- ness, must be made upon the idea that the air is clear, as, if by any accident it is otherwise, we shall (knowing the proportion in which clear air dims a prospect) be led to conclude this farther off than it is, and, to justify that conclusion, shall suppose its real magnitude correspondent with the distance, at which from its de- gree of distinctness it appears to be. In the circumstance remarked in the text there is, however, a great deception ; the fact is, that the colour and the minute parts of the object are lost in the fog, while the size of it is not diminished in proportion ; and the eye being accustomed to see objects diminished in size at a great dis- tance, supposes this to be farther off than it is, and consequently imagines it larger.


AERIAL PERSPECTIVE. 193

Chap. CCCXXl— Of those Objects ivhich theEijes perceive through a Mist or thick Air.

The nearer the air is to water, or to the ground, the thicker it becomes. It is proved by the nine- teenth proposition of the second book,* that bo- dies rise in proportion to their weight ; and it fol- lows, that a light body will rise higher than another which is heavy.

Chap. CCCXXII. — Miscellaneous Observations.

Of different objects equal in magnitude, form, shade, and distance from the eye, those will ap- pear the smaller that are placed on the lighter ground. This is exempUfied by observing the sun when seen behind a tree without leaves ; all the ramifications seen against that great light are so diminished that they remain almost invisible. The same may be observed of a pole placed between the sun and the eye.

Parallel bodies placed upright, and seen through a fog, will appear larger at top than at bottom. This is proved by the ninth proposition, f which says, that a fog, or thick air, penetrated by the rays of the sun, will appear whiter the lower they are.

  • This proposition, though uiuloubtedly intended to form apart

of some future work, which never was ckawn up, makes no part of the present.

t See chap, cccvii.

K


194 AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.

Things seen afar off will appear out of })ro- j)ortion, because the parts which are the lightest will send their image with stronger rays than the parts which are darkest. I have seen a woman dressed in black, with a white veil over her head, wliich appeared twice as large as her shoulders covered with black.


195


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.


LANDSCAPE.

Chap. CCCXXIIL — Of Objects seen at aDistance.

Any dark object will appear lighter when re- moved to some distance from the eye. It follows, by the contrary reason, that a dark object will ap- pear still darker when brought nearer to the eye. Therefore the inferior parts of any object what- ever, placed in thick air, will appear farther from the eye at the bottom than at the top ; for that reason the lower parts of a mountain appear far- ther off than its top, which is in reality the farthest.

Chap. CCCXXIV. — Of a Town seen through a thick Air.

The eye which, looking downwards, sees a town immersed in very thick air, will perceive the top of the buildings darker, but more distinct than the bottom. The tops detach against a light ground, because they are seen against the low and thick air which is beyond them. This is a consequence of what has been explained in the preceding chapter.

K 2


196 LANDSCAPE.

Chap. CCCXXV. — How to draw a Landscape.

Contrive that the trees in your landscape be half in shadow and half in the light. It is better to represent them as when the sun is veiled with thin clouds, because in that case the trees receive a general light from the sky, and are darkest in those parts which are nearest to the earth.

Chap. CCCXXVL— 0/^Ae Green of the Country.

Of the greens seen in the country, that of trees and other plants will appear darker than that of fields and meadows, though they may happen to be of the same quality.

Chap. CCCXXVIL— ^A«jf Greens will appear most of a blueish Cast.

Those greens will appear to approach nearest to blue which are of the darkest shade when remote. This is proved by the seventh proposition,* which says, that blue is composed of black and white seen at a great distance.

Chap. CCCXXVIIL— 7%e Colour of the Sea from different Aspects.

When the sea is a little ruffled it has no same- ness of colour ; for, whoever looks at it from the shore, wiU. see it of a dark colour, in a greater de-

  • Vide chap, ccxcii. ccciii.


LANDSCAPE. 197

gree as it approaches towards the horizon, and will perceive also certain lights moving slowly on the surface hke a flock of sheep. Whoever looks at the sea from on board a ship, at a distance from the land, sees it blue. Near the shore it appears darkish, on account of the colour of the earth re- flected by the water, as in a looking-glass ; but at sea the azure of the air is reflected to the eye by the waves in the same manner.

Chap. CCCXXIX. — Why the same Prospect ap- pears larger at some Times than at others.

Objects in the country appear sometimes larger and sometimes smaller than they actually are, from the circumstance of the air interposed between the eye and the horizon, happening to be either thicker or thinner than usual.

Of two horizons equally distant from the eye, that which is seen through the thicker air will appear farther removed ; and the other will seem nearer, being seen through a thinner air.

Objects of unequal size, but equally distant, will appear equal if the air which is between them and the eye be of proportionable inequality of thickness, viz. if the thickest air be interposed between the eye and the smallest of the objects. This is proved by the perspective of colours,* which is so deceit- ful that a mountain which would appear small by

  • See chap, ccxcviii.


198 LANDSCAPE.

the compasses, will seem larger than a small hill near the eye ; as a finger placed near the eye will cover a large mountain far off.

Chap. CCCXXX.— Of Smoke.

Smoke is more transparent, though darker, to- wards the extremities of its waves than in the middle.

It moves in a more oblique direction in propor- tion to the force of the wind which impels it.

Different kinds of smoke vary in colour, as the causes that produce them are various.

Smoke never produces determined shadows, and the extremities are lost as they recede from their primary cause. Objects behind it are less appa- rent in proportion to the thickness of the smoke. It is whiter nearer its origin, and bluer towards its termination.

Fire appears darker, the more smoke there is interposed between it and the eye.

Where smoke is farther distant, the objects are less confused by it.

It encumbers and dims all the landscape like a fog. Smoke is seen to issue from different places, with flames at the origin, and the most dense part of it. The tops of mountains will be more seen than the lower parts, as in a fog.


LANDSCAPE. 199

Chap. CCCXXXI. — /w what Part Smoke is- lightest.

Smoke which is seen between the sun and tlie eye will be hghter and more transparent than any other in the landscape. The same is observed of dust, and of fog ; while, if you place yourself be- tween the sun and those objects, they will appear dark.

Chap. CCCXXXII. — Of tlie Sun-beams passing through the Openings of Clouds.

The sun-beams which penetrate the openings interposed between clouds of various density and form, illuminate all the places over which they pass, and tinge with their own colour all the dark places that are behind : which dark places are only seen in the intervals between the rays.

Chap. CCCXXXIIL— O/Me Beginning of Rain.

When the rain begins to fall, it tarnishes and darkens the air, giving it a dull colour, but receives still on one side a faint light from the sun, and is shaded on the other side, as we observe in clouds; till at last it darkens also the earth, depriving it entirely of the light of the sun. Objects seen through the rain appear confused and of undeter- mined shape, but those which are near will be more distinct. It is observable, that on the side where the rain is shaded, objects will be more


200 LANDSCAPE.

clearly distinguished than where it receives the light ; because on the shady side they lose only their principal lights, whilst on the other they lose hoih their lights and shadows, the lights mixing with the light part of the rain, and the shadows are also considerably weakened by it.

Chap. CCCXXXIV.— 7%e Seasons are to be observed.

In Autumn you will represent the objects ac- cording as it is more or less advanced. At the beginning of it the leaves of the oldest branches only begin to fade, more or less, however, accord- ing as the plant is situated in a fertile or barren country; and do not imitate those who represent trees of every kind (though at equal distance) with the same quality of green. Endeavour to vary the colour of meadows, stones, trunks of trees, and all other objects, as much as possible, for Nature abounds in variety ad infinitum.

Chap. CCCXXXV.-T/^e Difference of Climates to be observed.

Near the sea-shore, and in southern parts, you will be careful not to represent the Winter season by the appearance of trees and fields, as you would do in places more inland, and in northern coun- tries, except when these are covered with ever- greens, which shoot afresh all the year round.


LANDSCAPE. 201

Chap. CCCXXXYL— Of Dust.

Dust becomes lighter the higher it rises, and appears darker the less it is raised, when it is seen between the eye and the sun.

Chap. CCCXXXYIL—Hoiv to represent the Wind.

In representing the effect of the wind, besides the bending of trees, and leaves twisting the WTong side upwards, you will also express the small dust whirling upwards till it mixes in a confused man- ner with the air.

Chap. CCCXXXVIII.-0/« miderness.

Tliose trees and shrubs which are by their na- ture more loaded with small branches, ought to be touched smartly in the shadows, but those which have larger fohage, will cause broader shadows.

Chap. CCCXXXIX.— 0/ the Horizon seen in the Water.

By the sixth proposition,* the horizon M-ill be seen in the water as in a looking-glass, on that side which is opposite the eye. And if the painter has to represent a spot covered with Water, let him remember that the colour of it cannot be

  • This was probably to have been a part of soire other work,

but it does not occur in this.

K 5


202 LANDSCAPE.

either lighter or darker than that of the neigh- bouring objects.

Chap. CCCXL. — Of the Shadow of Bridges on the Surface of the Water. The shadows of bridges can never be seen on the surface of the water, unless it should have lost its transparent and reflecting quality, and become troubled and muddy j because clear water being polished and smooth on its surface, the image of the bridge is formed in it as in a looking-glass, and reflected in all the points situated between the eye and the bridge at equal angles ; and even the air is seen under the arches. These circum- stances cannot happen Avhen the water is muddy, because it does not reflect the objects any longer, but receives the shadow of the bridge in the same manner as a dusty road would receive it.

Chap. CCCXIA.—How a Painter ought to put in Practice the Perspective of Colours.

To put in practice that perspective which teaches the alteration, the lessening, and even the entire loss of the very essence of colours, you must take some points in the country at the distance of about sixty-five yards* from each other; as trees, men, or some other remarkable objects. In regard to

  • Cento braccia, or cubits. The Florence braccio is one foot

ten inches seven-eighths, English measure.


VARIOUS PRECEPTS IN PAINTING, 203

the first tree, you will take a glass, and having fixed that well, and also your eye, draw upon it, with the greatest accuracy, the tree you see through it; then put it a little on one side, and compare it closely with the natural one, and colour it, so that in shape and colour it may resemble the original, and that by shutting one eye they may both ap- pear painted, and at the same distance. The same rule may be apphed to the second and third tree at the distance you have fixed. These studies will be very useful if managed with judgment, where they may be wanted in the ofFscape of a picture. I have observed that the second tree is less by four-fifths than the first, at the distance of thirteen yards.


Chap. CCCXLII . — Various Precepts in Pain ting.

The superficies of any opake body participates of the colour of the transparent medium interposed between the eye and such body, in a greater or less degree, in proportion to the density of such me- dium and the space it occupies.

The outlines of opake bodies will be less appa- rent in proportion as those bodies are farther dis- tant from the eye.

That part of the opake body will be the most shaded, or lightest, which is nearest to the body that shades it, or gives it light.


204 VARIOUS PRECEPTS IN PAINTING.

The surface of any opake body participates more or less of the colour of that body which gives it light, in proportion as the latter is more or less remote, or more or less strong.

Objects seen between lights and shadows will appear to have greater relievo than those which are placed wholly in the light, or wholly in shadow.

When you give strength and precision to objects seen at a great distance, they will appear as if they were very near. Endeavour that your imitation be such as to give a just idea of distances. If the object in nature appear confused in the outlines, let the same be observed in your picture.

The outlines of distant objects appear undeter- mined and confused, for two reasons : the first is, that they come to the eye by so small an angle, and are therefore so much diminished, that they strike the sight no more than small objects do, which though near can hardly be distinguished, such as the nails of the fingers, insects, and other similar things : the second is, that between the eye and the distant objects there is so much air inter- posed, that it becomes thick; and, like a veil, tinges the shadoAvs with its own whiteness, and turns them from a dark colour to another between black and white, such as azure.

Although, by reason of the great distance, the appearance of many things is lost, yet those things which receive the light from the sun will be more


VARIOUS PRECEPTS IX PAINTING. 20i»

discernible, while the rest remain enveloped in confused shadows. And because the air is thicker near the groiind, the things which are lower will appear confused ; and vice versa.

When the sun tinges the clouds on the horizon with red, those objects which, on account of their distance, appear blueish, will participate of that redness, and will produce a mixture between the azure and red, which renders the prospect lively and pleasant ; all the opake bodies which receive that light Mall appear distinct, and of a reddish co- lour, and the air, being transparent, v/ill be impreg- nated with it, and appear of the colour of lilies.*

The air which is between the earth and the sun when it rises or sets, will always dim the ol^jects it surrounds, more than the air any where else, because it is whiter.

It is not necessary to mark strongly the outlines of any object which is placed upon another. It ought to detach of itself.

If tlie outline or extremity of a white and curved surface terminate upon another white body, it will have a shade at that extremity, darker tlian any part of the light ; but if against a dark object, such outline, or extremity, will be lighter than any part of the light.

Tliose objects which are most different in colour, will appear the most detached from each other.

  • Probably the Autliorhere means yellow lilies, or fleurs de lis.


206 VARIOUS PRECEPTS IN PAINTIxVG.

Tliose parts of objects which first disappear in the distance, are extremities similar in colour, and ending one upon the other, as the extremities of an oak tree upon another oak similar to it. The next to disappear at a greater distance are, objects of mixed colours, when they terminate one upon the other, as trees, ploughed fields, walls, heaps of rubbish, or of stones. The last extremities of bo- dies that vanish are those which, being light, ter- minate ujion a dark ground ; or being dark, upon a light ground.

Of objects situated above the eye, at equal heights, the farthest removed from the eye will ap- pear the lowest; and if situated below the eye, the nearest to it will aj^pear the lowest. The parallel lines situated sidewise will concur to one point.*

Those objects which are near a river, or a lake, in the distant part of a landscape, are less appa- rent and distinct than those that are remote from them.

Of bodies of equal density, those that are nearest to the eye will appear thinnest, and the most re- mote thickest.

A large eye-ball will see objects larger than a small one. The experiment may be made by look- ing at any of the celestial bodies, through a pin-

  • That point is always found in the horizon, and is called the

point of sight, or the vanishing point.


VARIOUS PRECEPTS IN PAINTING. 207

hole, which being capable of admitting but a por- tion of its light, it seems to diminish and lose of its size in the same proportion as the pin-hole is smaller than the usual apparent size of the object.

A thick air interposed between the eye and any object, will render the outlines of such object un- determined and confused, and make it appear of a larger size than it is in reality; because the linear perspective does not diminish the angle which conveys the oljject to the eye. The aerial per- spective carries it farther off, so that the one re- moves it from the eye, while the other preserves its magnitude.*

When the sun is in the West the vapours of the earth fall down again and thicken the air, so that objects not enlightened by the sun remain dark and confused, but those which receive its light will be tinged yellow and red, according to the sun's ap2)earance on the horizon. Again, those that receive its light are very distinct, particularly public buildings and towns in houses and villages, because their shadows are dark, and it seems as if those parts which are plainly seen were coming out of confused and undetermined foundations, because at that time every thing is of one and the same colour, except wliat is eidightened by the sun.f

Any object receiving the liglit from the sun,

• See chap, cccxx. f See chap, cccxvii.


208 VARIOUS PRECEPTS IN PAINTING.

receives also the general light; so that two kinds of shadows are produced : the darkest of the two is that which happens to have its central line di- rected towards the centre of the sun. The central lines of the primitive and secondary lights are the same as the central lines of the primitive and se- condary shadows.

The setting sun is a beautiful and magnificent object when it tinges with its colour all the great buildings of towns, villages, and the top of high trees in the country. All below is confused and almost lost in a tender and general mass ; for, be- ing only enhghtened by the air, the difference l^e- tween the shadoAVs and the lights is small, and for that reason it is not much detached. But those that are high are touched by the rays of the sun, and, as was said before, are tinged with its colour; the painter therefore ought to take the same co- lour with which he has painted the sun, and em- ploy it in all those parts of his work which receive its light.

It also happens very often, that a cloud Avill ajj- pear dark without receiving any shadow from a separate cloud, according to the situation of the eye; because it will see only the shady part of the one, while it sees both the enlightened and shady parts of the other.

Of two objects at equal height, that which is the farthest off will appear the lowest. Observe the


VARIOUS PRECEPTS IN PAINTING.


209


first cloud in the cut, though it is lower than the second, it appears as if it were higher. This is demonstrated by the section of the pyramidical rays of the low cloud at M A, and the second



(which is higher) at N M, below M A. This hap- pens also when, on account of the rays of the set- ting or rising sun, a dark cloud appears higher than another which is light.


Chap. CCCXLIII.— r/^e Brilliancy of a Land- scape.

The vivacity and brightness of colours in a land- scape will never bear any comparison with a land- scape in nature when illumined by the sun, unless the picture be placed so as to receive the same light from the sun itself.


210


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.


Chap. CCCXLIV.— ^F^^y « painted Object does not appear so far distant as a real one, though they be conveyed to the Eye by equal Angles.

Ira house be painted on the pannel B C, at the



apparent distance of one mile, and by the side of it a real one be perceived at the true distance of one mile also ; which objects are so disposed, that the pannel, or picture, A C, intersects the p)Ta- midical rays with the same opening of angles ; yet these two objects will never appear of the same size, nor at the same distance, if seen with both eyes.*

  • This position has been already laid Aovra in chapter cxxiv.

(and will also be found in chapter cccxlviii.) ; and the reader is referred to the note on that passage, which will also explain that in the text, for further illustration. It may, however, be proper to re-


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.


211


Chap. CCCXLV. — How to draw a Figure standing upon its Feet, to appear forty Braccia * high, in a Space of twenty Braccia, ivith proportionate Members.

In this, as in any other case, the painter is not to mind what kind of surface he has to work upon j particularly if his painting is to be seen from a determined point, such as a window, or any other opening. Because the eye is not to attend to the evenness or roughness of the wall, but only to



mark, that though the author has here supposed both objects con- veyed to the eye by an angle of the same extent, they cannot, in fact, be so seen, unless one eye be shut; and the reason is this : if viewed with both eyes, there will be two points of sight, one in the centre of each eye; and the rays from each of these to the objects must of course be different, and will consequently form dif- ferent angles.

  • The braccio is one foot ten inches and seven-eighths English

measure.


212 MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.

what is to be represented as beyond that wall ; such as a landscape, or any thing else. Nevertheless a curved surface, such as F R G, would be the best, because it has no angles.

Chap. CCCXLVI. — How to draw a Figure twenty- four Braccia high, upon a Wall twelve Braccia high. Plate XXII.

Draw upon part of the wall M N, half the figure you mean to represent -, and the other half upon the cove above, M R. But before that, it will be necessary to draw upon a flat board, or a paper, the profile of the wall and cove, of the same shape and dimension, as that upon which you are to paint. Then draw also the profile of your figure, of whatever size you please, by the side of it ; draw all the Hnes to the point F, and where they intersect the profile M R, you will have the dimensions of your figure as they ought to be drawn upon the real spot. You will find, that on the straight part of the wall M N, it will come of its proper form, because the going off perpendicu- larly will diminish it naturally ; but that part which comes upon the curve will be diminished ujDon your drawing. The whole must be traced afterwards upon the real spot, which is similar to M N. This is a good and safe method.


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.


213


Chap. CCCXLVII. — IJ hy, on measuring a Face, and then painting it of the same Size, it will appear larger than the natural one.

A B is the breadth of the space, or of the head, and it is placed on the paper at the distance C F, where the cheeks are, and it would have to stand back all A C, and then the temples would be car- ried to the distance O R of the lines A F, B F; so that there is the difference C O and R D, It fol- lows that the line C F, and the Hne D F, in order to become shorter,* have to go and find the paper where the whole height is drawn, that is to say, the lines F A, and F B, where the true size is ; and so it makes the difference, as I have said, of C O, and R D.



i. e. To be abridged according to the niles of perspective.


214


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.


Chap. CCCXLVIII.— ^«y the most perfect Imi- tation of Nature will not appear to have the same Relief as Nature itself.

If nature is seen with two eyes, it will be impos- sible to imitate it upon a picture so as to appear with the same relief, though the lines, the Hghts, shades, and colour, be perfectly imitated.* It is proved thus : let the eyes A B, look at the object C, with the concurrence of both the central visual rays A C and B C. I say, that the sides of the visual angles (which contain these central rays) will see the space G D, behind the object C. The eye A will see all the space F D, and the eye B all the space G E. Therefore the two eyes will see behind the object C all the space F E; for which



reason that object C becomes as it were transpa- rent, according to the definition of transparent

  • See chap, cxjcii.


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS. 215

bodies, behind which nothing is hidden. This cannot happen if an object were seen with one eye only, provided it be larger than the eye. From all that has been said, we may conclude, that a painted object, occupying all the space it has be- hind, leaves no possible way to see any part of the ground, which it covers entirely by its own circumference.*

Chap. CCCXLIX. — Universality of Painting ; a Precept.

A painter cannot be said to aim at universality in the art, unless he love equally every species of that art. For instance, if he delight only in landcape, his can be esteemed only as a simple investigation; and, as our friend Botticelli remarks,

  • The whole of this chapter, like the next but one preceding, depends on the circumstance of there being in fact two points of sight, one in the centre of each eye, when an object is viewed with both eyes. In natural objects the effect which this circumstance produces is, that the rays from each point of sight, diverging as they extend towards the object, take in not only that, but some part also of the distance behind it, till at length, at a certain distance behind it, they cross each other ; whereas, in a painted representation, there being no real distance behind the object, but the whole being a flat surface, it is impossible that the rays from the points of sight should pass beyond that flat surface ; and as the object itself is on that flat surface, which is the real extremity of the view, the eyes cannot acquire a sight of any thing beyond.
  • A well-known painter at Florence, contemporary with Leonardo da Vinci, who painted several altar-pieces and other public works.

is but a vain study ; since, by throwing a sponge impregnated with various colours against a wall, it leaves some spots upon it, which may appear like a landscape. It is true also, that a variety of compositions may be seen in such spots, according to the disposition of mind with which they are considered; such as heads of men, various animals, battles, rocky scenes, seas, clouds, woods, and the like. It may be compared to the sound of bells, which may seem to say whatever we choose to imagine. In the same manner also, those spots may furnish hints for compositions, though they do not teach us how to finish any particular part; and the imitators of them are but sorry landscape-painters.

Chap. CCCL. — Imvhat Maimer the Mirror is the true Master of Painters.

When you wish to know if your picture be like the object you mean to represent, have a flat look- ing-glass, and place it so as to reflect the object you have imitated, and compare carefully the ori- ginal with the copy. You see upon a flat mirror the representation of things which appear real; Painting is the same. They are both an even su- perficies, and both give the idea of something be- yond their superficies. Since you are persuaded that the looking-glass, by means of lines and shades, gives you the representation of things as if they were real ; you being in possession of co-


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS. 217

lours which in their different lights and shades are stronger than those of the looking-glass^ may cer- tainly, if "you employ the rules with judgment, give to your picture the same appearance of Nature as you admire in the looking-glass. Or rather, your picture will be like Nature itself seen in a large looking-glass.

This looking-glass (being your master) will show you the lights and shades of any object whatever. Amongst your colours there are some Ughter than the lightest part of your model, and also some darker than the strongest shades ; from which it follows, that you ought to represent Nature as seen in your looking-glass, when you look at it with one eye only; because both eyes surround the objects too much, particularly when they are small.*

Chap. CCCLI. — Ifldch Painting is to be esteemed the best.

That painting is the most commendable which has the greatest conformity to what is meant to be imitated. This kind of comparison will often put to shame a certain description of painters, who pretend they can mend tlie works of Nature ; as they do, for instance, when they pretend to repre- sent a child twelve months old, giving him eight heads in height, Avhen Nature in its best propor-

  • See chapters ccxxiv. and cccxlviii.

I4


J18 MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATION'S.

tion admits but five. The breadth of the shoulders also, which is equal to the head, they make double, giving to a child a year old, the proportions of a man of thirty. They have so often practised, and seen others practise these errors, that they have converted them into habit, which has taken so deep root in their corrupted judgment, that they persuade themselves that Nature and her imitators are wrong in not following their own practice.*

Chap. CCCLII. — Of the Judgment to he made of a Painter^s Work.

The first thing to be considered is, whether the figures have their proper rehef, according to their respective situations, and the light they are in : that the shadows be not the same at the extremi- ties of the groups, as in the middle ; because be- ing surrounded by shadows, or shaded only on one side, produce very different effects. The groups in the middle are surrounded by shadows from the other figures, which are between them and the light. Those which are at the extremities have the shadows only on one side, and receive the light on the other. The strongest and smartest touches of shadows are to be in the interstice between the figures of the principal group where the fight can- not penetrate.f

Secondly, that by the order and disposition of

  • See chap. x. t See chap. cci.


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS. 219

the figures they appear to be accommodated to the subject, and the true representation of the history in question.

Thirdly, that the figures appear aUve to the occa- sion which brought them together, with expres- sions suited to their attitudes.

Chap. CCCLIII. — How to make an imaginary Animal appear natural.

It is evident that it will be impossible to invent any animal without giving it members, and these members must individually resemble those of some known animal.

If you wish, therefore, to make a chimera, or imaginary animal, appear natural (let us suppose a serpent) ; take the head of a mastiff, the eyes of a cat, the ears of a porcupine, the mouth of a hare, the brows of a lion, the temples of an old cock, and the neck of a sea tortoise.*

Chap. CCCLIV. — Painters are not to imitate one another.

One painter ought never to imitate the manner of any other ; because in that case he cannot be called the child of Nature, but the grandchild. It is always best to have recourse to Nature, which

  • Leonardo da Vinci was remarkably fond of this kind of in-

ventions, and is accused of having lost a great deal of time that way.

L 2


220 MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.

is replete with such abundance of objects, than to the productions of other masters, who learnt every thing from her.

Chap. CCCLV. — How to judge of one's own Work.

It is an acknowledged fact, that we perceive errors in the works of others more readily than in our own. A painter, therefore, ought to be well instructed in perspective, and acquire a perfect knowledge of the dimensions of the human body; he should also be a good architect, at least as far as concerns the outward shape of buildings, with their different parts ; and where he is deficient, he ought not to neglect taking drawings from Nature.

It will be well also to have a looking-glass by him, when he paints, to look often at his work in it, which being seen the contrary way, will appear as the work of another hand, and will better shew his faults. It will be useful also to quit his work often, and take some relaxation, that his judgment may be clearer at his return ; for too great apph- cation and sitting still is sometimes the cause of many gross errors.

Chap. CCCLVl. — Of correcting Errors which you discover.

Remember, that when, by the exercise of your


kiSCELLANEOtTS OBSERVATIONS. 1?21

own judgment, or the observation of others, you discover any errors in your work, you immediately set about correcting them, lest, in exposing your works to the public, you expose your defects also. Admit not any self-excuse, by persuading yourself that you shall retrieve your character, and that by some succeeding work you shall make amends for your shameful negligence ; for your work does not perish as soon as it is out of your hands, like the sound of music, but remains a standing monu- ment of your ignorance. If you excuse yourself by saying that you have not time for the study necessary to form a great painter, having to strug- gle against necessity, you yourself are only to blame ; for the study of what is excellent is food both for mind and body. How many philoso- phers, born to great riches, have given them away, that they might not be retarded in their pursuits !

Chap. CCCLVIL— T^e best Place for looking at a Picture.

Let us suppose, that A B is the picture, re- ceiving the hght from D ; I say, that whoever is placed between C and E will see the picture very badly, particularly if it be painted in oil, or var- nished ; because it will shine, and will appear al- most of the nature of a looking-glass. For these reasons, the nearer you go towards C, the less you


222 MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.

will be able to see, because of the light from the window upon the picture, sending its reflection to that point. But if you place yourself between E D, you may conveniently see the picture, and the more so as you draw nearer to the point D, because that place is less Uable to be struck by the reflected rays.


Rest of the chapters

Chap. CCCLVIIL— 0/ Judgment.

There is nothing more apt to deceive us than our own judgment, in deciding on our own works; and we should derive more advantage from having our faults pointed out by our enemies, than by hearing the opinions of our friends, because they are too much like ourselves, and may deceive us as much as our own judgment.

Chap. CCCLIX. — Of Employment anxiously wished for by Painters.

And you, painter, who are desirous of great


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS. 223

practice, understand, that if you do not rest it on the good foundation of Nature, you will labour with little honour and less profit ; and if you do it on a good ground, your works will be many and good, to your great honour and advantage.

Chap. CCCLX. — Advice to Painters.

A painter ought to study universal Nature, and reason much within himself on all he sees, making use of the most excellent parts that compose the species of every object before him. His mind will by this method be like a mirror, reflecting truly every object placed before it, and become, as it were, a second Nature.

Chap. CCChXl.— Of Statuary.

To execute a figure in marble, you must first make a model of it in clay, or plaster, and when it is finished, place it in a square case, equally ca pable of receiving the block of marble intended tr be shaped like it. Have some peg-like sticks to pass through holes made in the sides, and all round the case ; push them in till every one touches the model, marking what remains of the sticks outwards with ink, and making a counter- mark to every stick and its hole, so that you may at pleasure replace them again. Then having taken out the model, and placed the block of mar- ble in its stead, take so much out of it, till all the


224 MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.

pegs go in at the same holes to the marks you had made. To faciUtate the work, contrive your frame so that every part of it, separately, or all together, may be lifted up^ except the bottom, which must remain under the marble. By this method you may chop it off with great facility*.

Chap. CCCLXII. — On the Measurement and Di- vision of Statues into Parts.

Divide the head into twelve parts, each part in- to twelve degrees, each degree into twelve mi- nutes, and these minutes into seconds f.

Chap. CCCLXIIL— ^ Precept for the Painter.

The painter who entertains no doubt of his own ability, will attain very little. "VNTien the work succeeds beyond the judgment, the artist acquires nothing ; but when the judgment is superior to the work, he never ceases improving, if the love of gain do not retard his progress.

  • The method here recommended, was the general and com-

mon practice at that time, and continued so with little, if any variation, tiU lately. But about thirty years ago, the late Mr. Bacon invented an entirely new method, which, as better answer- ing the purpose, he constantly used, and from him others have also adopted it into practice.

t This may be a good method of di%ading the figure for the purpose of reducing from large to small, or vice versa ,- but it not being the method generally used by the painters for measuring their figures, as being too minute, this chapter was not introduced amongst those of general proportions.


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS. 225

Chap. CCCLXIV. — On the Judgment of Painters. When the work is equal to the knowledge and judgment of the painter, it is a bad sign; and when it surpasses the judgment, it is still worse, as is the case with those who wonder at ha^^ng succeeded so weU. But when the judgment sur- passes the work, it is a perfectly good sign ; and the young painter who possesses that rare dispo- sition, wiU, no doubt, arrive at great perfection. He will produce few works, but they will be such as to fix the admiration of every beholder.

Chap. CCCLXV. — That a Man ought not to trust to himself, but ought to comult Nature.

Whoever flatters himself that he can retain in his memory all the effects of Nature, is deceived, for our memory is not so capacious ; therefore consult Natvire for ever)' thing.


L 5

TABLE OF CHAPTERS.

The Number at the End of each Title refers to the corres- ponding Chapter in the original Edition in Italian.


D R A A^M N G.

PROPORTtON. CHAP.

1. What the young Student in Painting ought in the

first Place to learn. Chapter 1.

2. Rule for a young Student in Painting. 3.

3. How to discover a young Man's Disposition for

Painting. 4.

4. Of Painting, and its Divisions. 47. .5. Division of the Figure. 48.

6. Proportion of Members. 49.

7. Of Dimensions in general. 173.

8. Motion, Changes, and Proportion of Members. 166. y. The Difference of Proportion between Children and

grown Men. 169

10. The Alterations in the Proportion of the human

Body from Infancy to full Age. 167.

1 1. Of the Proportion of Members. 1 Jo-

12. That every Part be proportioned to its Whole. 250.

13. Of the Proportion of the Members. 185.


228 TABLE OF CHAPTERS.

CHAP.

14. The Danger of forming an erroneous Judgment in

regard to the Proportion and Beauty of the Parts. 42.

15. Another Precept. 12.

16. The Manner of drawing from Relievos, and render-

ing Paper fit for it. 127. 17- Of drawing from Casts or Nature. SI.

18. To draw Figures from Nature 38.

19. Of drawing from Nature. 25.

20. Of drawing Academy Figures. 30.

21. Of studying in the Dark, on first waking in the

Morning, and before going to Sleep. 1 7.

22. Observations on drawing Portraits. 188

23. The Method of retaining in the Memory the Like-

ness of a Man, so as to draw his Portrait, after having seen him only once. 189.

24. How to remember the Form of a Face. 190.

25. That a Painter should take Pleasure in the Opinion

of every Body. 19.

ANATOMY.

26. What is principally to be observed in Figures. 213.

27. Mode of Studying. 7.

28. Of being universal. 22.

29. A Precept for the Painter. 5.

30. Of the Measures of the human Body, and the bend-

ing of Members. 1 74.

31. Of the small Bones in several Joints of the human

Body. 229.

32. Memorandum to be observed by the Painter. 57.

33. The Shoulders. 171.

34. The Difference of Joints between Children and

grown Men. 168.


TABLE OF CHAPTERS. 229

CHAP.

35. Of the Joints of the Fingers. 170.

36. Of the Joint of the Wrist. 176.

37. Of the Joint of the Foot. 177.

38. Of the Knee. 178.

39. Of the Joints. 179.

40. Of the Naked. 220.

41. Of the Thickness of the Muscles. 221.

42. Fat Subjects have small Muscles. 222.

43. Which of the Muscles disappear in the dififerent Mo-

tions of the Body. 223.

44. Of the Muscles. 226.

45. Of the Muscles. 224.

46. The Extension and Contraction of the Muscles. 227. 47- Of the Muscle between the Chest and the lower

Belly. 230.

48. Of a Man's complex Strength, but first of the

Arm. 234,

49. In which of the two Actions, Pulling or Pushing, a

Man has the greatest Power, Plate II. 235.

50. Of the bending of Members, and of the Flesh round

the bending Joint. 236.

51. Of the naked Body. 180.

52. Of a Ligament without Muscles. 228.

53. Of Creases. 238.

54. How near behind the Back one Arm can be brought

to the other. Plate III. and IV. 232.

55. Of the Muscles. 225.

56. Of the Muscles. 194.

57. Of the bending of the Body, 204.

58. The same Subject. 205.

59. The Necessity of anatomical Knowledge. 43,


230 TABLE OF CHAPTERS.

MOTION AND EQUIPOISE OF FIGURES. CHAP.

60. Of the Equipoise of a Figure standing still. 20.3.

61. Motion produced by the Loss of Equilibrium. 208.

62. Of the Equipoise of Bodies, Plate V. 263.

63. Of Positions. 192.

64. Of balancing the Weight round the Centre of Gra-

vity in Bodies. 214.

65. Of Figures that have to lift up, or carry any Weight.

215. C6. The Equilibrium of a Man standing upon his Feet,

Plate VL 201. (^7. Of Walking, Plate VII. 202.

68. Of the Centre of Gravity in Men and Animals. 199.

69. Of the corresponding Thickness of Parts on each

Side of the Body. 269.

70. Of the Motions of Animals. 249.

71. Of Quadrupeds and their Motions. 2G8.

72. Of the Quickness or Slowness of Motion. 267.

73. Of the Motion of Animals 299.

7 A. Of a Figure moving against the Wn\^,PlateVIII. 295.

75. Of the Balance of a Figure resting upon its Feet. 266.

76. A Precept. 350.

77 . Of a Man standing, but resting more upon one Foot

than the other. 264.

78. Of the Balance of Figures, Plate IX. 209.

79. In what Manner extending one Arm alters the Ba-

lance. 198.

80. Of a Man bearing a Weight on his Shoulders, Plate

X. 200.

81. Of Equilibrium. 206.

82. Of Motion. 195.

83. The Level of the Shoulders. 196.


TABLE OF CHAPTERS. 231

CHAP.

84. Objection to the above answered, Plate XL and

XII. 197.

85. Of the Position of Figures, Plate XIII. 89.

86. Of the Joints. 184.

87. Of the Shoulders. 172.

88. Of the Motions of a Man. 207.

89. Of the Disposition of Members preparing to act with

great Force, Plate XIV. 233.

90. Of throwing any Thing with Violence,PlateXV. 26 1 .

91. On the Motion of driving anything into or drawing

it out of the Ground. 262.

92. Of forcible Motions, Plate XVI. 181.

93. The Action of Jumping. 260.

94. Of the three Motions in jumping upwards. 270.

95. Of the easy Motions of Members. 211.

96. The greatest Twist which a Man can make, in turn-

ing to look at himself behind, Plate XVII. 23 1 .

97. Of turning the Leg without the Thigh. 237.

98. Postures of Figures. 265.

99. Of the Gracefulness of the Members. 210.

100. That it is impossible for any Memory to retain the

Aspects and Changes of the Members. 2/1.

101. The Motions of Figures. 242.

102. Of common Motions. 248.

103. Of simple Motions. 239.

104. Complex Motions. 240.

105. Motions appropriated to the Subject. 241.

106. Appropriate Motions. 245.

107. Of the Postures of Women and young People. 259.

108. Of the Postures of Cliildren. 258.

109. Of the Motion of the Members. 186.

110. Of mental Motions. 246.

111. Effect of the Mind upon the Motions of the Body,

occasioned by some outward Object. 247.


232 TABLE OF CHAPTERS.


LINEAR PERSPECTIVE. CHAP.

112. Of those who apply themselves to the Practice, with-

out having learnt the Theory of the Art. 23.

113. Precepts in Painting. 349,

114. Of the Boundaries of Objects called OutUnes or

Contours 291.

11.5. Of linear Perspective. 322.

116. What Parts of Objects disappear first by Dis- tance. 318.

117- Of remote Objects. 316.

118. Of the Point of Sight. 281.

1 19- A Picture is to be viewed from one Point only. 59.

120. Of the Dimensions of the first Figure in an his-

torical Painting. 91.

121. Of Objects that are lost to the Sight, in Propor-

tion to their Distance. 292.

122. Errors not so easily seen in small Objects as in

large ones. 52.

123. Historical Subjects one above another on the same

Wall to be avoided. 54.

124. Why Objects in Painting can never detach as na-

tural Objects do. 53.

125. How to give the proper Dimension to Objects in

Painting. 71.

126. How to draw accurately any particular Spot. 32.

127. Disproportion to be avoided, even in the accessory

Parts. 290.


INVENTION OR COMPOSITION.

1 28. Precept for avoiding a bad Choice in the Style or Proportion of Figures. 45-


TABLli OF CHAPTERS. 233

CHAP.

129. Variety in Figures. 21.

130. How a Painter ought to proceed in his Studies. 6-

131. Of sketching Histories and Figures. 13.

132. How to study Composition. 90-

133. Of the Attitudes of Men. 2 1 6.

134. Variety of Positions. 217-

135. Of Studies from Nature for History, 37.

136. Of the Variety of Figures in History Painting. 94-

137. Of Variety in History. 97.

138. Of the Age of Figures. 252.

139. Of Variety of Faces. 98.

140. A Fault in Painters, 44.

141. How you may learn to compose Groups for History

Painting. 90.

142. How to study the Motions of the human Body. 95.

143. Of Dresses, and of Draperies and Folds. 358.

144. Of the Nature of Folds in Draperies. 359.

145. How the Folds of Draperies ought to be represented,

Plate XVIII. 360.

146. How the Folds in Draperies ought to be made, 361.

147. Fore-shortening of Folds, P/a^e X/X 362.

148. Of Folds. 364.

149. Of Decorum. 251.

150. The Character of Figures in Composition. 253.

151. The Motion of the Muscles, when the Figures are

in natural Positions. 193.

152. A Precept in Painting, 58.

1 53. Of the Motion of Man, Plate XX. and XXI. 1 82.

154. Of Attitudes, and the Motions of the Members. 1 83.

155. Of a single Figure separate from an historical

Group. 212.

156. On the Attitudes of the human Figure. 218-

157. How to represent a Storm. 66.

158. How to compose a Battle. 67.


234 TABLE OF CHAPTERS

CHAP.

159. The Representation of an Orator and his Au- dience. 254.

IGO. Of demonstrative Gestures. 243.

] G 1 . Of the Attitudes of the Bye-standers at some re- markable Event. 219.

1G2. How to represent Night. fi5.

1G3. Tlie Method of awakening the Mind to a Variety of Inventions. 16.

1G4. Of Composition in History. 93.


EXPRESSION AND CHARACTER,

165. Of expressive Motions. 50.

166. How to paint Children. 61. 167- How to represent old Men. 62.

168. How to paint old Women. 63.

169. How to paint Women. 64.

170. Of the Variety of Faces. 244.

171. The Parts of the Face, and their Motions. 187.

172. Laughing and Weeping. 257.

173. Of Anger. 255.

174. Despair. 256.


LIGHT AND SHADOW.

175. The Course of Study to be pursued. 2.

1 7&, Which of the two is the most useful Knowledge,

the Outlines of Figures, or that of Light and

Shadow. 56.

177. Which is the most important, the Shadow or Out-

lines in Painting. 277-

178. What is a Painter's first Aim and Object. 305.


TABLE OF CHAPTERS. 235

CHAP.

179. The Difference of Superficies, in regard to Painting.

278.

180. How a Painter may become universal. 10.

181. Accuracy ought to be learnt before Dispatch in the

Execution. 18.

182. How the Painter is to place himself in regard to

the Light, and his Model. 40.

183. Of the best Light. 41,

184. Of drawing by Candle-light. 34.

18.5. Of those Painters who draw at Home from one Light, and afterwards adapt their Studies to another Situation in the Country, and a dif- ferent Light. 46.

185. How high the Light should be in drawing from

Nature. 27.

187. What Light the Painter must make use of to give

most Relief to his Figures. 55.

188. Advice to Painters. 26.

189. Of Shadows. 60.

190. Of the kind of Light proper for drawing from Re-

lievos, or from Nature. 29.

191. Whether the Light should be admitted in Front

or sideways ; and which is the most pleasing and graceful. 74,

192. Of the Difference of Lights according to the Situa-

tion. 289.

193. How to distribute the Light on Figures, 279.

194. Of the Beauty of Faces. 191.

195. How, in drawing a Face, to give it Grace, by the

Management of Light and Shade. 35.

196. How to give Grace and Relief to Faces. 287.

1 97. Of the Termination of Bodies upon each other. 294 .

198. Of the Back-grounds of painted Objects. 154.


236 Table of cuAPTfeRS.

CHAP.

199. How to detach and bring forward Figures out of

their Back-ground. 288,

200. Of proper Back-grounds. 141.

201. Of the general Light diffused over Figures. 303.

202. Of those Parts in Shadows which appear the dark-

est at a Distance. 327.

203. Of the Eye viewing the Folds of Draperies sur-

rounding a Figure. 363.

204. Of the Rehef of Figures remote from the Eye. 336.

205. Of Outlines of Objects on the side towards the

Light. 337.

206. How to make Objects detach from their Ground,

that is to say, from the Surface on which they are painted. 342.

CONTRASTE AND EFFECT.

207. A Precept. 343.

208. Of the Interposition of transparent Bodies between

the Eye and the Object. 357.

209. Of proper Back-grounds for Figures. 283.

210. Of Back-grounds. 160.

REFLEXES.

211. Of Objects placed on a light Ground, and why

such a Practice is useful in Painting. 159.

212. Of the different Effects of White, according to the

Difference of Back-grounds. 139.

213. Of Reverberation. 75.

214. Where there cannot be any Reverberation of Light.

215. In what Part the Reflexes have more or less bright-

ness. 7Q.

216. Of the reflected Lights which surround the Sha-

dows. 78.


TABLE OF CUAPTERS. 237

CHAP.

217. Where Reflexes are to be most apparent. 82.

218. What Part of a Reflex is to be the lightest. 80.

219. Of the Termination of Reflexes on their Grounds. 88.

220. Of double and treble Reflexions of Light. 83.

221. Reflexes in the Water, and particularly those of

the Air. 135.


COLOURS AND COLOURING.

COLOURS.

222. What Surface is best calculated to receive most

Colours. 123.

223. What Surface will shew most perfectly its true

Colour. 125.

224. On what Surface the true Colour is least ap-

parent. 131.

225. W^hat Surfaces shew most of their true and genuine

Colour. 132.

226. Of the Mixture of Colours. 121.

227. Of the Colours produced by the Mixture of other

Colours, called secondary Colours. 161.

228. Of Verdigris. 119.

229. How to increase the Beauty of Verdigris. 120.

230. How to paint a Picture that will last almost for

ever. 352.

231 . The Mode of painting on Canvass, or Linen Cloth.

353.

232. Of lively and beautiful Colours. 100.

233. Of transparent Colours. 113.

234. In what Part a Colour will appear in its greatest

Beauty. 114.

235. How any Colour without Gloss, is more beautiful

in the Lights than in the Shades. 115.


238 TABLE OF CHAPTERS.

CHAP.

236. Of the Appearance of Colours. 1 16.

237. What part of a Colour is to be the most beautiful.

117.

238. That the Beauty of a Colour is to be found in the

Lights. 118.

239. Of Colours. 111.

240. No Object appears in its true Colour, unless the

Light which strikes upon it be of the same Colour. 150.

241. Of the Colour of Shadows. 147.

242. Of Colours. 153.

243. Whether it be possible for all Colours to appear

alike by means of the same Shadow. 109.

244. Why White is not reckoned among the Colours. 155 .

245. Of Colours. 156.

246. Of the Colouring of remote Objects. 339.

247. The Surface of all opaque Bodies participates of the

Colour of the surrounding Objects. 298.

248. General Remarks on Colours. 162.

COLOURS IN REGARD TO LIGHT AND SHADOW.

249. Of the Light proper for painting Flesh Colour from

Nature. 36.

250. Of the Painter's Window. 296.

251. The Shadows of Colours. 101.

252. Of the Shadows of White. 104.

253. Which of the Colours will produce the darkest

Shade. 105.

254. How to manage, when a White terminates upon

another White. 138.

255. On the Back-grounds of Figures. 140.

256. The Mode of composing History. 92.

257. Remarks concerning Lights and Shadows. 302,


TABLE OF CHAPTERS. 239

CHAP.

258. Why the Shadows of Bodies upon a white Wall are

blueish towards the Evening. 328.

259. Of the Colour of Faces. 126.

260. A Precept relating to Painting. 284.

261. Of Colours in Shadow. 158.

262. Of the Choice of Limits. 28.


COLOURS IN REGARD TO BACK-GROUNDS.

263. Of avoiding hard Outlines. 5 1 .

264. Of Outlines, 338.

265. Of Back-grounds, 334.

266. How to detach Figures from the Ground. "0. 26". Of Uniformity and Variety of Colours upon plain

Surfaces. 304.

268. Of Back-grounds suitable both to Shadows and

Lights. 137.

269. The apparent Variation of Colours, occasioned by

the Contraste of the Ground upon which they are placed. 1 12.

CONTRASTE, HARMONY, AND REFLEXES, IX REGARD TO COLOURS.

270. Gradation in Painting. 144.

271. How to assort Colours in such a Manner as that

they may add Beauty to each other. 99.

272. Of detaching the Figures. 73.

273. Of the Colour of Reflexes. S7.

274. What Body will be most strongly tinged with the

Colour of any other Object. 1 24.

275. Of Reflexes. 77.

276. Of the Surface of all shadowed Bodies. 122.


240 TABLE OF CHAPTERS.

CHAP.

277. That no reflected Colour is simple, but is mixed with

the Nature of the other Colours. 84.

278. Of the Colour of Lights and Reflexes. 157.

2/9. Why reflected Colours seldom partake of the Colour of the Body where they meet. 85.

280. The Reflexes of Flesh Colours. 81.

281. Of the Nature of Comparison. 146.

282. Where the Reflexes are seen. 86.


PERSPECTIVE OF COLOURS.

283. A Precept of Perspective in regard to Painting. 354.

284. Of the Perspective of Colours. 134.

285. The Cause of the Diminution of Colours. 136.

286. Of the Diminution of Colours and Objects. 356.

287. Of the Variety observable in Colours, according to

their Distance or Proximity. 102.

288. At what Distance Colours are entirely lost. 103.

289. Of the Change observable in the same Colour, ac-

cording to its Distance from the Eye. 1 28.

290. Of the blueish Appearance of remote Objects in a

Landscape. 317.

291. Of the Qualities in the Surface which first lose

themselves by Distance. 293-

292. From what Cause the Azure of the Air proceeds. 151.

293. Of the Perspective of Colours. 107.

294. Of the Perspective of Colours in dark Places. 148.

295. Of the Perspective of Colours. 149.

296. Of Colours. 152.

297. How it happens that Colours do not change, though

placed in different Quahties of Air. 108.

298. WhyColours experience no apparent Change, though

placed in diflerent Quahties of Air. 106.


TABLE OF CHAPTERS. 241

CHAP.

299. Contrary Opinions in regard to Objects seen afar

oflF. 142.

300. Of the Colour of Objects remote from the Eye. 143.

301 . Of the Colour of Mountains. 163.

302. Why the Colour and Shape of Objects are soft iu

some Situations apparently dark, though not so in Reality. 110.

303. Various Precepts in Painting. 340.

AERIAL PERSPECTIVE.

304. Aerial Perspective 165.

305. The Parts of the smallest Objects will first disap-

pear in Painting. 306.

306. Small Figures ought not to be toomuch finished. 282

307. Why the Air is to appear whiter as it approache

nearer to the Earth. 69.

308. How to paint the distant Part of a Landscape. 68.

309. Of precise and confused Objects. 72.

310. Of distant Objects. 355.

311. Of Buildings seen in a thick Air. 312.

312. Of Towns and other Objects seen through a thick

Air. 309.

313. Of the inferior Extremities of distant Objects. 315.

314. Which Parts of Objects disappear first by being re-

moved farther from the Eye, and which pre- serve their Appearance. 321.

315. W^hy Objects are less distinguished in proportion as

they are farther removed from the Eye. 319.

3 1 6. Why Faces appear dark at a Distance. 320.

317. Of Towns and other Buildings seen through a Fot?

in the Morning or Evening. 325.

318. Of the Height of Buildings seen in a Fog. 324.


242 TABLE OF CHAPTERS.

CHAP.

319. Why Objects which are high, appear darker at a

Distance than those which are low, though the Fog be uniform, and of equal Thickness- 326.

320. Of Objects seen in a Fog. 323.

321. Of those Objects which the Eye perceives through

a Mist or thick Air. 311.

322. Miscellaneous Observations. 308.


MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.

LANDSCAPE.

323. Of Objects seen at g. Distance. 313.

324. Of a Town seen through a thick Air. 314. 325- How to draw a Landscape. 33-

326. Of the Green of the Country. 129.

327. WhatGreens will appear most of a blueish Cast. 130.

328. The Colour of the Sea from different Aspects. 145.

329. Why the same Prospect appears larger at some

Times than at others. 307.

330. Of Smoke. 331.

331. In what Part Smoke is lightest. 329.

332. Of the Sun-beams passing through the Openings of

Clouds. 310.

333. Of the Beginning of Rain. 347-

334. The Seasons are to be observed. 345.

335. The Difference of Climates is to be observed. 344.

336. Of Dust. 330.

337. How to represent the Wind. 346.

338. Of a Wilderness. 285.

339 Of the Horizon seen in the Water. 365. 340. Of the Shadow of Bridges on the Surface of the Water. 348.


TABLE OF CHAPTERS. 243

CHAP.

.341. How a Painter ought to put iu Practice the Per- spective of Colours. 164.

342. Various Precepts in Painting. 332.

343. The brilliancy of a Landscape. 133.

MISCELLANEOUS OBSERVATIONS.

344. Why a Painted object does not appear so far dis-

tant as a real one, though they be conveyed to the Eye by equal Angles. 333,

345. How to draw a figure standing upon its Feet, to

appear forty Braccia high, in a space of twenty Braccia, with proportionate Members. 300.

346. How to draw a figure twenty-four Braccia high, upon

a Wall twelve Braccia high, Plate XXII. 301.

347. Why, on measuring a Face, and then painting it of

the same Size, it will appear larger than the natural one. 297.

348. Why the most perfect Imitation of Nature will not

appear to have the same Relief as Nature itself. 341.

349. Universality of Painting. A Precept. 9.

350. In what Manner the Mirror is the true Master of

Painters. 275.

351. Which Painting is to be esteemed the best. 276.

352. Of the Judgment to be made of a Painter's Work.

335.

353. How to make an imaginary Animal ajipear natural.

286,

354. Painters are not to imitate one another. 24.

355. How to judge of one's own AVork. 274.

356. Of correcting Errors which you discover. 14.

357. The best Place for looking at a Picture. 280.

358. Of Judgment. 15.


244 TABLE OF chapters;

CHAP.

359. Of Employment anxiously wished for by Painters.

272.

360. Advice to Painters. 8.

361. Of Statuary. 351.

362. On the Measurement and Division of Statues into

Parts. 39.

363. A Precept for the Painter. 1 1 .

364. Ou the Judgment of Painters. 273.

365. That a Man ought not to trust to himself, but

ought to consult Nature. 20,


THE END.





Unless indicated otherwise, the text in this article is either based on Wikipedia article "A Treatise on Painting" or another language Wikipedia page thereof used under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License; or on research by Jahsonic and friends. See Art and Popular Culture's copyright notice.

Personal tools